Lantronix Switch 900 510 User Manual

SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
Part Number 900-510  
Revision C October 2013  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disclaimer & Revisions  
Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause interference, in which  
case the user, at his or her own expense, will be required to take whatever measures  
may be required to correct the interference.  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for  
Class A digital device pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are  
designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the  
equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates,  
uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in  
accordance with this User Guide, may clause interference to radio  
communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to  
cause interference, in which case the user will be required to correct the  
interference at his own expense.  
The user is cautioned that changes and modifications made to the equipment  
without approval of the manufacturer could void the user’s authority to operate  
this equipment.  
Changes or modifications to this device not explicitly approved by Lantronix will void the  
user's authority to operate this device.  
The information in this guide may change without notice. The manufacturer assumes no  
responsibility for any errors that may appear in this guide.  
Date  
Rev. Comments  
Initial Release  
September 2007  
May 2008  
A
B
New web page design with tabbed menus.  
Added support for the following: Sensorsoft devices; SecureID  
over Radius; command and status of the SLP power manager  
expansion chassis; escape and break sequences for remote  
users; password aging, iGoogle Gadget; SNMP v3 encryption;  
ability to copy boot bank; host lists for outgoing modem and  
direct connection at the CLI; new option for local users to  
display a custom menu at login.  
Updated product name and trademark information.  
October 2013  
C
Warranty  
For details on the Lantronix warranty replacement policy, please go to our web site at  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Table of Contents  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
List of Figures  
List of Tables  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1: About This Guide  
Purpose and Audience  
This guide provides the information needed to install, configure, and use the Lantronix®  
SLB™ branch office manager. The SLB branch office manager is for IT professionals  
who must remotely and securely configure and administer servers, routers, switches,  
telephone equipment, or other devices equipped with a serial port for facilities that are  
typically remote branch offices or "distributed" IT locations.  
Chapter Summaries  
The remaining chapters in this guide include:  
Chapter  
Summary  
Describes the SLB models, their main features, and the protocols  
they support.  
Provides technical specifications; describes connection formats  
and power supplies; provides instructions for installing the SLB  
branch office manager in a rack.  
Provides instructions for getting your SLB device up and running  
and for configuring required settings.  
Describes the web and command line interfaces available for  
configuring the SLB branch office manager.  
Note: The configuration chapters (6-12) provide detailed  
instructions for using the web interface and include equivalent  
command line interface commands.  
Provides instructions for configuring network ports, firewall and  
routing settings, and the date and time.  
Provides instructions for enabling and disabling system logging,  
SSH and Telnet logins, SNMP, SMTP, and the date and time.  
Provides instructions for configuring global device port settings,  
individual device port settings, and console port settings.  
Provides instructions for using the PC Card slot.  
Provides instructions for configuring connections and viewing,  
updating, or disconnecting a connection.  
Provides instructions for enabling or disabling methods that  
authenticate users who attempt to log in via SSH, Telnet, or the  
console port. Provides instructions for creating custom menus.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
1: About This Guide  
Chapter  
Summary  
Provides instructions for upgrading firmware, viewing system logs  
and diagnostics, generating reports, and defining events. Includes  
information about web pages and commands used to shut down  
and reboot the SLB device.  
Shows how to set up and use the SLB branch office manager in  
three different configurations.  
Lists and describes all of the commands available on the SLB  
command line interface  
Lists and describes the commands available for the bootloader  
command line interface.  
Provides tips for enhancing SLB security.  
Lists safety precautions for using the SLB branch office manager.  
Includes adapter pinout diagrams.  
Lists the protocols supported by the SLB unit with brief  
descriptions.  
Provides information about the SLB device’s compliance with  
industry standards.  
Additional Documentation  
Visit the Lantronix Web site at www.lantronix.com/support/documentation for the latest  
documentation and the following additional documentation.  
SLB Branch Office Manager  
Quick Start  
Describes the steps for getting the SLB branch office  
manager up and running.  
SLB Online Help for the  
Command Line Interface  
Provides online help for configuring the SLB device using  
commands.  
SLB Online Help for the Web  
Interface  
Provides online help for configuring the SLB branch office  
manager using the web page.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2: Overview  
The SLB branch office manager enables IT System Administrators to manage remote  
servers and IT infrastructure equipment securely over the Internet. This innovative device  
combines the capabilities of the award-winning Lantronix® SLC™ console manager with  
remote power management and an Ethernet switch into a compact, 1U rack-mountable  
appliance.  
Features  
Console Management  
8 serial ports for console connectivity  
Enables system administrators to remotely manage Linux, Unix, and  
Windows 2003 servers, routers, switches, telecom, and building access  
equipment  
Provides data logging, monitoring, and secure access control via the Internet  
Power Management Outlets for Power Connectivity  
4 outlets for power connectivity  
Provides ability to control power individually to all attached equipment  
Provides on/off/reboot control  
Ensures safe power distribution and reduces in-rush current overload  
Ethernet Switch  
8 ports for network connectivity  
Provides additional flexibility and scalability  
Offers convenience  
Reduces rack space  
Integration with Other Secure IT Management Products  
Can be combined with the Lantronix® Spider™ Distributed KVM to provide  
a complete all-in-one “distributed IT” management solution.  
Can integrate seamlessly with the Lantronix® SLM™ management appliance  
and brings the “Branch to the Enterprise” for a complete end-to-end OOBI  
enterprise management solution.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
2: Overview  
Meets Needs of Branch Offices  
Designed to meet the specific needs of the remote branch office, the SLB branch office  
manager conserves rack space and reduces costs by enabling system administrators at  
a main corporate facility to manage the IT equipment distributed among branch offices  
simply and cost-effectively.  
Branch offices are facilities that are typically remote or “distributed IT” locations, likely  
located off-site of corporate headquarters or large-scale enterprise facilities. These  
distributed facilities typically do not have an on-site maintenance staff or IT System  
Administrator.  
Typically, the branch office environment has some of the following characteristics:  
Space is limited to 1U rack space or shelf mounted desktop unit  
Closet-mounted or wall-attached rack  
Limited air and power conditioning  
Limited number of network devices and servers  
No on-site maintenance staff  
Ethernet or dial-up modem access is required  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2: Overview  
Typical Equipment  
You can configure, administer, and manage IT equipment in a variety of ways, but most  
devices have one method in common: an RS-232 serial port, sometimes called a  
console, auxiliary, or management port. These ports are often accessed directly by  
connecting a terminal or laptop to them, meaning that the user must be in the same  
physical location as the equipment. SLB devices give the user a way to access them  
remotely from anywhere there is a network or modem connection.  
The SLB can access and administer many types of equipment, such as:  
Servers: Unix, Linux, Windows 2003, and others  
Networking equipment: Routers, switches, storage networking  
Telecom: PBX, voice switches  
Other systems with serial interfaces: Heating/cooling systems,  
security/building access systems, UPS, medial device.  
Types of Business  
The SLB branch office manager is used in many types of business, for example:  
Banking and finance  
Insurance companies  
Healthcare  
Retail Sales  
Information Technology  
Education and campus style facilities  
Hospitality  
Manufacturing Facilities  
Benefits  
The key benefits of using the SLB branch office manager:  
Saves space: Compact design merges the functionality of three solutions into a  
1U rack solution, reducing required rack space and total cost of ownership.  
Saves money: Enables remote management and troubleshooting without  
sending a technician onsite, resulting in reduced travel costs and increased  
network uptime.  
Saves time: Provides instant access and reduces response time, improving  
efficiency.  
Simplifies access: Enables 24/7 access to your equipment securely and  
remotely after hours and on weekends and holidays—without having to schedule  
visits or arrange for off-hour access.  
Protects assets: Provides the highest levels of encryption and security features  
(authentication, authorization, and IP filters) to ensure that your IT infrastructure  
and data assets are protected.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2: Overview  
The SLB device also provides features such as convenient text menu systems, break-  
safe operation, port buffering (logging), remote authentication, and Secure Shell (SSH)  
access. Dial-up modem support ensures access when the network is not available.  
Models  
Two SLB models have the following hardware components:  
Two Models: The SLB branch office manager is available in a 100-120 VAC  
output model (SLB088411-01) with NEMA 5-15R type outlets and a 208-240  
VAC output model (SLB088412-01) with IEC60320/C13 type outlets.  
Power Outlets: Each model has four outlets that allow power management  
and control (on/off/reboot) of the attached equipment using a simple web or  
command line interface.  
Serial Device Ports: Eight serial RS-232C (EIA-232) device ports are for  
remote console management of the attached equipment. These match the  
RJ45 pin-outs of the console ports of many popular devices found in a  
network environment, and where different can be converted using Lantronix  
adapters. See D: Adapters and Pinouts for more information on serial  
adapters and pin-outs.  
Unmanaged Ethernet Switch: A built-in 8-port unmanaged Ethernet switch  
provides convenience and helps further reduce required rack space.  
Ports and Modem Slots: The SLB branch office manager has two 10/100  
Ethernet ports (referred to in this User Guide as Eth1 and Eth2) and a front  
panel serial console port (RJ45). The SLB device has two 32-bit CardBus  
(PC card) slots to support storage cards or a PC Card modem for dial-in  
access. The list of supported cards is available on the Lantronix website.  
Table 2-1. SLB Models  
Part Number  
Model and Description  
SLB088411-01  
SLB branch office manager, 8 device ports, 8 Ethernet switch  
ports, 4 power outlets (100-120 VAC, NEMA 5-15R type), 1 AC  
power supply  
SLB088412-01  
SLB branch office manager, 8 device ports, 8 Ethernet switch  
ports, 4 power outlets (208-240 VAC, IEC60320/C13 type), 1  
AC power supply  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2: Overview  
Figure 2-1. SLB 8 Front  
Two-Line  
LCD Display  
Front Panel  
Pushbuttons  
Two PC Card Slots  
1U Tall, Self-Contained  
Rack-Mountable Chassis  
Console Port  
(RS-232)  
Figure 2-2. SLB 8 Back — 8 Device Ports, 4 Power Outlets, 8 Switch Ports; 1 AC Power Supply  
Two 10/100 Network Ports  
RS-232 Device Ports (1-8)  
8 Switch Ports  
Four Power Outlets  
AC Power Input  
System Features  
The SLB firmware has the following basic capabilities:  
Connects up to eight RS-232 serial consoles  
Controls power (on/off/reboot) of up to four attached devices  
10Base-T/100Base-TX Ethernet network compatibility  
Buffer logging to file  
Email and SNMP notification  
ID/Password security, configurable access rights  
Secure shell (SSH) security; supports numerous other security protocols  
Network File System (NFS) and Common Internet File System (CIFS) support  
Telnet or SSH to a serial port by IP address per port or by IP address and TCP  
port number  
Configurable user rights for local and remotely authenticated users  
Support for an internal PC Card modem or an external modem  
Sun break-safe (no unintentional break ever sent to attached servers)  
Simultaneous access on the same port-- "listen" and "direct" connect mode  
Local access through a console port  
Web administration (using most browsers)  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2: Overview  
Protocols Supported  
The SLB branch office manager supports the TCP/IP network protocol as well as:  
SSH, Telnet, PPP, NFS, and CIFS for connections in and out of the SLB device  
SMTP for mail transfer  
DNS for text-to-IP address name resolution  
SNMP for remote monitoring and management  
FTP and SFTP for file transfers and firmware upgrades  
TFTP and HTTPS for firmware upgrades  
DHCP and BOOTP for IP address assignment  
HTTPS (SSL) for secure browser-based configuration  
NTP for time synchronization  
LDAP, NIS, RADIUS, CHAP, PAP, Kerberos, and TACACS+ for user  
authentication  
For brief descriptions of these protocols, see Appendix Protocol Glossary.  
Access Control  
The system administrator controls access to attached servers or devices by assigning  
access rights to up to 128 user profiles. Each user has an assigned ID, password, and  
access rights. Other user profile access options may include externally configured  
authentication methods such as RADIUS, TACACS+, NIS, and LDAP.  
Power Outlet Control  
With the SLB branch office manager’s built-in power management capability, system  
administrators can remotely control the power (on/off/reboot) individually to all IT  
equipment in the branch office, ensure safe power distribution, and reduce “in-rush”  
current overload. If SNMP traps are enabled, a trap (alarm) is sent if the total current for  
all outlets exceeds a threshold.  
Device Port Buffer  
The SLB device supports real-time data logging for each device port. The port can save  
the data log to a file, send an email notification of an issue, or take no action.  
You can define the path for logged data on a port-by-port basis, configure file size and  
number of files per port for each logging event, and configure the device log to send an  
email alert message automatically to the appropriate parties indicating a particular error.  
Configuration Options  
You may use the backlit front-panel LCD display for initial setup and configuration and to  
view current network, console, and date/time settings, and get power outlet status.  
Both a web interface viewed through a standard browser and a command line interface  
(CLI) are available for configuring the SLB settings and monitoring performance.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
2: Overview  
Application Example  
The figure below is an example deployment. An SLB branch office manager is deployed  
in each branch office and an (optional) SLM management appliance at the main office.  
The branch offices are interconnected (always on) by VPN routers overlaid on the  
Internet, and also interconnected (on demand) through the analog phone system.  
Note: The SLB branch office manager can also be the authentication gateway to a  
network architecture that is not VPN-based.  
The SLB device provides Ethernet switch service (blue), remotely controlled and  
monitored AC power (orange), console management (green), and traditional, wired  
telephone network (PSTN) access (yellow).  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2: Overview  
A system administrator, upon losing IP connectivity to a server, takes the following steps:  
Views the server’s Ethernet interface state information provided by the SLB  
branch office manager.  
If the Ethernet interface is faulty, connects to the server’s console port by means  
of the SLB web page or CLI (optionally via the SLM management appliance) and  
checks the server’s system parameters.  
If the server is not responsive on the console port, commands the SLB branch  
office manager to reboot the server’s power.  
If the entire branch office loses IP connectivity, dial in to the SLB device to  
perform the diagnostic functions  
Hardware Features  
The SLB hardware includes the following:  
1U-tall (1.75 inch) rack-mountable appliance  
2 10Base-T/100Base-TX network ports  
1 front panel serial console port for VT100 terminal or PC with emulation  
2 PC Card slots  
Front panel LCD display and keypad  
256 KB-per-port buffer memory for serial device ports  
8-port unmanaged Ethernet switch with auto MDI/MDIX function  
8 RS-232 serial device ports connected via Category 5 (RJ45) wiring  
AC Power Input:  
SLB088411-01 model:  
- (1) IEC-60320/C20 inlet, 100-120 VAC, 50/60Hz  
- (20A Branch Circuit) 16A max input current2  
- (15A Branch Circuit) 12A max input current1  
SLB088412-01 model:  
- (1) IEC-60320/C20 inlet, 100-240 VAC, 50/60Hz  
- (20A Branch Circuit) 15A max input current  
Power Outlets (Total Switched Power):  
SLB088411-01 model:  
- (4) NEMA 5-15R outlets, 100-120 VAC, 50/60Hz  
- (20A Branch Circuit) 15A max per outlet, 16A total2  
- (15A Branch Circuit) 12A max per outlet, 12A total1  
SLB088412-01 model  
- (4) IEC-60320/C13 outlets, 208-240 VAC, 50/60Hz  
- (20A Branch Circuit) 10A max per outlet, 15A total  
Note: The outlet voltage equals the input voltage.  
Convection cooled, silent operation, low power consumption  
Note: For more detailed information, see Technical Specifications on  
page 23.  
1 The max input/output current is de-rated to 12A when using the supplied NEMA  
5-15P (15A) cable (p/n SLPP012310-01).  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2: Overview  
2 The max input/output current is de-rated to 16A when using the optional NEMA  
5-20P (20A) cable (p/n SLPP012410-01, SLPP012510-01, SLPP012610-01).  
Serial Connections  
All devices attached to the device ports and the console port must support the RS-232C  
(EIA-232) standard. Category 5 cabling with RJ45 connections is used for the device port  
connections and for the console port. (For pinout information, see D: Adapters and  
Pinouts.)  
Note: RJ45 to DB9/DB25 adapters are available from Lantronix.  
Device ports and the console port support eight baud-rate options: 300, 600, 1200, 2400,  
4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, and 115200 baud.  
Figure 2-3. Device Port Connections  
Figure 2-4. Console Port Connection  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2: Overview  
Network Connections  
The SLB network interfaces are 10Base-T/100Base-TX connectors for use with a  
conventional Ethernet network. Use standard RJ45-terminated Category 5 cables.  
Network parameters must be configured before the SLB branch office manager can be  
accessed over the network.  
Note: One possible use for the two Ethernet ports is to have one port on a  
private, secure network and the other on a public, unsecured network.  
Figure 2-5. Network Connection  
PC Card Interface  
The SLB has two PC Card slots. Lantronix qualifies cards continuously and publishes a  
list of qualified cards on the Lantronix web site.  
Figure 2-6. PC Card Interface  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3: Installation  
This chapter provides a high-level procedure for installing the SLB branch office manager  
followed by more detailed information about the SLB connections and power supplies.  
Caution: To avoid physical and electrical hazards, please be sure to read  
C: Safety Information before installing the SLB device.  
What’s in the Box  
In addition to the SLB branch office manager, the box contains the following items:  
Part #  
Component Description  
Adapters:  
200.2066A  
200.2067A  
Adapter: DB25M (DCE), Sun w/DB25 female  
Adapter: DB25F (DCE) to RJ45, Sun w/DB25 male and some  
HP9000’s  
200.2069A  
200.2070A  
Adapter: DB9M (DCE) to RJ45, SGI Onyx  
Adapter: DB9F (DCE) to RJ45, HP9000, SGI Origin, IBM RS6000,  
and PC-based Linux servers  
ADP010104-01  
Adapter: RJ45 rolled serial, Cisco, and Sun Netra  
Note: An optional adapter for external modems is also available from Lantronix: 200.2073  
Adapter: DB25M (DCE) to RJ45, external modems.  
Cables:  
500-184-R  
200.0063  
500-153  
Cable: RJ45 to RJ45, Cat-5, 1 Ft (.3m)  
Cable: RJ45 to RJ45, Cat-5, 6.6 ft (2 m)  
Cable: RJ45 Loopback  
Power Cords:  
SLPP12310-01*  
SLPP12810-01**  
SLPP12910-01**  
SLPP12A08-01**  
Inlet cord: IEC60320/C19 to NEMA 5-15P (15A), 8 FT.  
Inlet cord: IEC60320/C19 to Schuko (EU), 8 Ft.  
Inlet cord: IEC60320/C19 to BS1363 (UK), 8 Ft.  
Inlet cord: IEC60320/C19 to AS3112 (AUS/NZ), 8 Ft.  
Notes: * Included with SLB088411E-01, ** Included with  
SLB088412E-01  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3: Installation  
Verify and inspect the contents of the SLB package using the enclosed packing slip or  
the table above. If any item is missing or damaged, contact your place of purchase  
immediately.  
Product Information Label  
The product information label on the underside of the SLB branch office manager  
contains the following information about each SLB device:  
Part Number  
Serial Number Bar Code  
Serial Number and Date Code  
Regulatory Certifications and Statements  
Technical Specifications  
Table 3-1. SLB Technical Specifications  
Serial Interface (Device)  
Serial Interface (Console)  
Power Input  
(8) RJ45-type 8-conductor connector (DTE)  
Speed software selectable (300 to 115,200 baud)  
(1) RJ45-type 8-pin connector (DTE)  
Speed software selectable (300 to 115,200 baud)  
Model SLB088411-01:  
- (1) IEC-60320/C20 inlet, 100-120 VAC, 50/60Hz  
- (20A Branch Circuit) 16A max input current 2  
- (15A Branch Circuit) 12A max input current 1  
Model SLB088412-01:  
- (1) IEC-60320/C20 inlet, 100-240 VAC, 50/60Hz  
- (20A Branch Circuit) 15A max input current  
Power Outlets  
Model SLB088411-01:  
- (4) NEMA5-15R outlets, 100-120 VAC, 50/60Hz  
- (20A Branch Circuit) 15A max per outlet, 16A total2  
- (15A Branch Circuit) 12A max per outlet, 12A total1  
Model SLB088412-01:  
- (4) IEC60320/C13 outlets, 208-240 VAC, 50/60Hz  
- (20A Branch Circuit) 10A max per outlet, 15A total  
Ethernet Switch  
Network Interface  
Power Supply  
(8) Ethernet switch ports (unmanaged) with auto MDI/MDIX  
10Base-T/100Base-TX RJ45 Ethernet  
(1) Universal AC power input: 100-240 VAC, 50 or 60 Hz  
IEC-type regional cord set included  
Power Consumption  
Dimensions  
Weight  
Less than 20 watts  
1U, 1.75 in x 17.25 in x 12 in  
10 lb.  
Temperature  
Operating: 0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F)  
Storage: -20 to 70 °C (-4 to 158 °F)  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3: Installation  
Relative Humidity  
Heat Flow Rate  
Operating: 10% to 90% non-condensing  
Storage: 10% to 90% non-condensing  
68 BTU per hour  
± 12%  
Current measurement  
accuracy  
1 The max input/output current is de-rated to 12A when using the supplied NEMA  
5-15P (15A) cable (p/n SLPP012310-01).  
2 The max input/output current is de-rated to 16A when using the optional NEMA  
5-20P (20A) cable (p/n SLPP012410-01, SLPP012510-01, SLPP012610-01).  
Physical Installation  
To install the SLB branch office manager in a rack:  
1. Place the SLB device in a 19-inch rack.  
Warning: Be careful not to block the air vents on the sides of the SLB  
branch office manager. If you mount the SLB in an enclosed rack, we  
recommended that the rack have a ventilation fan to provide adequate  
airflow through the SLB.  
2. Connect the serial device(s) to the SLB device ports. See on page 25.  
3. Install any PC Cards you intend to use. If you install a modem card, connect to the  
phone line. See 9: PC Cards.  
4. You have the following options:  
a) To configure the SLB branch office manager using the network, or to monitor  
serial devices on the network, connect at least one SLB network port to a  
b) To configure the SLB branch office manager using a dumb terminal or a  
computer with terminal emulation, connect the terminal or PC to the SLB  
5. Connect the power cord, and apply power. See Connecting to a Power Source on  
page 26 .  
6. Wait approximately a minute and a half for the boot process to complete.  
When the boot process ends, the SLB host name and the clock appear on the LCD  
display.  
Now you are ready to configure the network settings as described in 4: Quick Setup.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3: Installation  
Connecting to a Device Port  
You can connect any device that has a serial console port to a device port on the SLB  
branch office manager for remote administration. The console port must support the RS-  
232C interface.  
Note: Many servers must either have the serial port enabled as a console or the  
keyboard and mouse detached. Consult the server hardware and/or software  
documentation for more information.  
To connect to a device port:  
1. Connect one end of the Cat 5 cable to the device port.  
2. Connect the other end of the Cat 5 cable to a Lantronix serial console adapter.  
Note: To connect a device port to a Lantronix® SLP™ management appliance, use the  
rolled serial cable provided with the SLB branch office manager, a 200.2225 adapter and  
Cat 5 cabling, or the ADP010104 adapter that eliminates the need for an additional Cat5  
patch cable between the adapter and the connected equipment. See D: Adapters and  
Pinouts for more information about Lantronix adapters.  
3. Connect the adapter to the serial console of the serial device.  
Figure 3-1. CAT 5 Cable Connection  
Connecting to a Network Port  
The SLB device’s network ports (10Base-T/100Base-TX) allow remote access to the  
attached devices and the system administrative functions. Use a standard RJ45-  
terminated Category 5 cable to connect to the network port.  
Note: One possible use for the two Ethernet ports is to have one port on a  
private, secure network, and the other on an unsecured network.  
Connecting a Terminal  
The console port is for local access to the SLB branch office manager and the attached  
devices. You may attach a dumb terminal or a computer with terminal emulation to the  
console port. The SLB console port uses RS-232C protocol and supports VT100  
emulation. The default baud rate is 9600.  
To connect the console port to a terminal or computer with terminal emulation, Lantronix  
offers optional adapters that provide a connection between an RJ45 jack and a DB9 or  
DB25 connector. The console port is configured as DTE. For more information,  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3: Installation  
Cable/Adapter Lookup on the Support menu.  
To connect a terminal:  
1. Attach the Lantronix adapter to your terminal (use PN 200.2066A adapter) or your  
PC's serial port (use PN 200.2070A adapter).  
2. Connect the Cat 5 cable to the adapter, and connect the other end to the SLB  
console port.  
3. Turn on the terminal or start your computer’s communication program (e.g.,  
HyperTerminal for Windows).  
4. Once the SLB branch office manager is running, press Enter to establish  
connection. You should see the model name and a login prompt on your terminal.  
You are connected.  
Connecting to a Power Source  
The SLB branch office manager consumes less than 20W of electrical power.  
The SLB device has a universal auto-switching AC power supply. The power supply  
accepts AC input voltage between 100 and 240 VAC with a frequency of 50 or 60 Hz.  
Rear-mounted IEC-type AC power connector(s) are provided for universal AC power  
input (see page 22 for included power cords).  
Figure 4-2. AC Power Input  
Connecting Devices to Power Outlets  
To avoid the possibility of noise due to arcing:  
1. Keep the device’s on/off switch in the off position until after it is plugged into  
the outlet, or log in to the unit and turn the outlets off before connecting the  
devices.  
2. Connect devices to the outlets.  
There are four power outlet status LEDs next to outlet number 1. The status LED  
for outlet 1 is at the top. If the LED for an outlet is dark the outlet is turned off; if it is  
lit the outlet is turned on.  
Figure 3-2. Power Outlets  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3: Installation  
The status of the power outlets displays on the front panel LCD display as the  
default display.  
Connecting Devices to the 8-Port Ethernet Switch  
To connect devices to the unmanaged Ethernet switch:  
1. Use the included 1Ft Ethernet patch cable to connect Ethernet port 1 on the SLB  
branch office manager to one of the switch ports.  
Figure 3-3. 8-Port Ethernet Switch  
Note: The eight unmanaged Ethernet ports are not internally connected  
to the other two Ethernet ports.  
2. Use a standard Ethernet patch cable to connect another switch port to your  
network.  
3. Up to 6 more Ethernet devices may be connected to your network. Use standard  
Ethernet patch cables from the Ethernet devices to the SLB device's switch ports.  
An example of a standard Ethernet patch cable is the Lantronix 200.0062 RJ45 TO  
RJ45 CAT5 CABLE (LAN PINNING) 6.6 Ft.  
Typical Installations  
Following are illustrations showing some typical ways to install the SLB branch office  
manager. In Figure 3-4, three serial devices (a server, a Cisco switch, and a firewall)  
connect to the SLB device's serial ports, unmanaged switch ports, and power outlets.  
This setup enables the SLB branch office manager to manage the devices, connect the  
devices to the network, and provide power to the devices. An SLB switch port connects  
the Lantronix Spider (optional), a “Distributed KVM” product that provides remote and  
secure access to the attached server over the network. In addition, the SLB branch office  
manager connects to a modem for out-of-band dial-up access.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3: Installation  
Figure 3-4. SLB Installation Using the Integrated Ethernet Switch  
In Figure 3-5, the SLB branch office manager controls four serial devices and  
provides power to them. The devices use a managed switch to connect to the  
network. The figure also shows how Lantronix Spiders can be daisy chained.  
Figure 3-5. SLB Installation Using a Managed Switch  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4: Quick Setup  
This chapter helps get the IP network port up and running quickly, so you can administer  
the SLB branch office manager using your network. To set up the network connections  
quickly, we suggest you do one of the following:  
Use the front panel LCD display and pushbuttons.  
Complete the Quick Setup web page on the web interface.  
SSH to the command line interface and follow the Quick Setup script on the  
command line interface.  
Connect to the console port and follow the Quick Setup script on the  
command line interface.  
Note: The first time you power up the SLB unit, Eth1 tries to obtain its IP address  
via DHCP. If you have connected Eth1 to the network, and Eth1 is able to acquire  
an IP address, you can view this IP address on the LCD or Lantronix® Detector™  
(downloadable at http://www.lantronix.com/support/downloads/). If Eth1 cannot  
acquire an IP address, you cannot use Telnet, SSH, or the web interface to run  
Quick Setup.  
IP Address  
Your SLB branch office manager must have a unique IP address on your network. The  
system administrator generally provides the IP address and corresponding subnet mask  
and gateway. The IP address must be within a valid range, unique to your network, and  
in the same subnet as your PC.  
You have the following options for assigning an IP address to your SLB device.  
Table 4-1. Methods of Assigning an IP Address  
Method  
DHCP  
Description  
A DHCP server automatically assigns the IP address and network  
settings. The SLB branch office manager is DHCP-enabled by  
default.  
With the Eth1 network port connected to the network, and the SLB  
device powered up, Eth1 acquires an IP address, viewable on the  
LCD.  
At this point, you can Telnet into the SLB branch office manager, or  
use the web interface.  
BOOTP  
Similar to DHCP but for smaller networks.  
Detector  
A Windows-based application downloadable at  
provided IP address or for assigning a static IP address to the SLB  
branch office manager. You can use Detector only if you have not  
already assigned a static IP address by another method. For more  
information, see Detector’s online help.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4: Quick Setup  
Method  
Description  
Front panel LCD  
display and  
pushbuttons  
You manually assign the IP address and other basic network,  
console, and date/time settings. If desired, you can restore the  
factory defaults.  
Serial port login to  
command line  
interface  
You assign an IP address and configure the SLB branch office  
manager using a terminal or a PC running a terminal emulation  
program to the SLB device’s serial console port connection.  
Method #1 Using the Front Panel Display  
Before You Begin  
Make sure you know:  
An IP address that will be unique and valid on your network (unless  
automatically assigned)  
Subnet mask (unless automatically assigned)  
Gateway  
DNS settings  
Date, time, and time zone  
Console port settings: baud rate, data bits, stop bits, parity, and flow control  
Make sure the SLB branch office manager is plugged in to power and turned on.  
Front Panel LCD Display and Pushbuttons  
With the SLB device powered up, you can use the front panel display and pushbuttons to  
set up the basic parameters.  
Figure 4-1. Front Panel LCD Display and Five Pushbuttons (Enter, Up, Down, Left, Right)  
The front panel display initially shows the hostname (abbreviated to 14 letters), total  
current level, and state of the four outlets.  
When you click the right-arrow pushbutton, the SLB device's network settings display.  
Using the five pushbuttons, you can change the network, console port, and date/time  
settings and view the firmware release version. If desired, you can restore the factory  
defaults.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
4: Quick Setup  
Note: Have your information handy as the display times out without accepting  
any unsaved changes if you take more than 30 seconds between entries.  
Any changes made to the network, console port, and date/time settings take effect  
immediately.  
Navigating  
The front panel has one Enter button (in the center) and four arrow buttons (up, left,  
right, and down). Press the arrow buttons to navigate from one option to another, or to  
increment or decrement a numerical entry of the selected option. Use the Enter button to  
select an option to change or to save your settings.  
Action  
Button  
To move to the next option (e.g., from Network Settings to  
Console Settings)  
right arrow  
To return to the previous option  
To enter edit mode  
left arrow  
Enter (center button)  
up and down arrows  
Within edit mode, to increase or decrease a numerical  
entry  
right or left arrows  
Enter  
Within edit mode, to move the cursor right or left  
To exit edit mode  
up and down arrows  
To scroll up or down the list of parameters within an option  
(e.g., from IP Address to Mask)  
Table 4-2. Front Panel Setup Options with Associated Parameters  
right/left arrow  
Normal  
Network  
Settings  
Console  
Settings  
Date /  
Time  
Release  
Settings  
Eth1 IP Address  
Eth1 Subnet Mask  
Gateway  
Baud Rate  
Data Bits  
Stop Bits  
Parity  
Time Zone  
Date/Time  
Firmware version and  
date code (display only)  
up/down arrow  
Restore Factory  
Defaults  
DNS1  
Flow Control  
DNS2  
DNS3  
Entering the Settings  
To enter setup information:  
1. From the normal display (host name, date and time), press the right arrow button  
to display Network Settings. The IP address for Eth1 displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4: Quick Setup  
Note: If you have connected Eth1 to the network, and Eth1 is able to acquire  
an IP address through DHCP, this IP address displays, followed by the letter  
[D]. Otherwise, the IP address displays as all zeros (000.000.000.000).  
2. Press the Enter button on the keypad to enter edit mode. A cursor displays below  
one character of the existing IP address setting.  
3. To enter values:  
Use the left or right arrow to move the cursor to the left or to the right position.  
Use the up or down arrow to increment or decrement the numerical value.  
4. When you have the IP address as you want it, press Enter to exit edit mode, and  
then press the down arrow button. The Subnet Mask parameter displays.  
Note: You must edit the IP address and the Subnet Mask together for a valid  
IP address combination.  
5. To save your entries for one or more parameters in the group, press the right  
arrow button. The Save Settings? Yes/No prompt displays.  
Note: If the prompt does not display, make sure you are no longer in edit  
mode.  
6. Use the left/right arrow buttons to select Yes, and press the Enter button.  
7. Press the right arrow button to move to the next option, Console Settings.  
8. Repeat steps 2-7 for each setting.  
9. Press the right arrow button to move to the next option, Date/Time Settings, and  
click Enter to edit the time zone.  
a) To enter a US time zone, use the up/down arrow buttons to scroll through the  
US time zones, and then press Enter to select the correct one.  
b) To enter a time zone outside the US, press the left arrow button to move up to  
the top level of time zones. Press the up/down arrow button to scroll  
through the top level.  
A time zone with a trailing slash (such as Africa/) has sub-time zones. Use the  
right arrow button to select the Africa time zones, and then the up/down  
arrows to scroll through them.  
Press Enter to select the correct time zone. To move back to the top-level time  
zone at any time, press the left arrow.  
10. To save your entries, press the right arrow button. The Save Settings? Yes/No  
prompt displays.  
Note: If the prompt does not display, make sure you are no longer in edit  
mode.  
11. Use the left/right arrow buttons to select Yes, and press the Enter button.  
12. To review the saved settings, press the up or down arrows to step through the  
current settings.  
When you are done, the front panel returns to the clock display. The network port  
resets to the new settings, and you can connect to your IP network for further  
administration. You should be able to Telnet or SSH to the SLB branch office  
manager through your network connection, or access the web interface through a  
web browser.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4: Quick Setup  
Restoring Factory Defaults  
To use the LCD display to restore factory default settings:  
1. Press the right arrow button to move to the last option, Release.  
2. Use the down arrow to move to the Restore Factory Defaults option. A prompt  
for the 6-digit Restore Factory Defaults password displays.  
3. Press Enter to enter edit mode.  
4. Using the left and right arrows to move between digits and the up and down  
arrows to change digits, enter the password (the default password is 999999).  
Note: The Restore Factory Defaults password is only for the LCD. You can change  
it at the command line interface using the admin keypad passwordcommand.  
5. Press Enter to exit edit mode. If the password is valid, a Save Settings? Yes/No  
prompt displays.  
6. To initiate the process for restoring factory defaults, select Yes. When the process  
is complete, the SLB reboots.  
Method #2 Quick Setup on the Web Page  
After the unit has an IP address, you can use the Quick Setup web page to configure the  
remaining network settings. This page displays the first time you log into the SLB only.  
Otherwise, the SLB Home Page displays. (For information about the web interface, see  
Web Interface on page 40.)  
To complete the Quick Setup page:  
1. Open a standard web browser. Lantronix supports the latest versions of Internet  
Explorer, Mozilla Firefox, Safari, Opera or Chrome web browsers.  
2. In the URL field, type https:// followed by the IP address of your SLB.  
Note: The web server listens for requests on the unencrypted (HTTP) port (port 80)  
and redirects all requests to the encrypted (HTTPS) port (port 443).  
3. Log in using sysadmin as the user name and PASS as the password. The first  
time you log in to the SLB, the Quick Setup page automatically displays.  
Otherwise, the Home page displays.  
Note: To open the Quick Setup page at another time, click the Quick Setup tab.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4: Quick Setup  
4. To accept the defaults, select the Accept default Quick Setup settings checkbox  
in the top portion of the page and click the Apply button at the bottom of the page.  
Otherwise, continue with step 5.  
Note: Once you click the Apply button on the Quick Setup page, you can  
continue using the web interface to configure the SLB branch office manager  
further.  
5. Enter the following:  
Network Settings  
Note: Configurations with the same IP subnet on multiple interfaces (Ethernet or PPP)  
are not currently supported.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4: Quick Setup  
Eth 1 Settings  
Disabled: If selected, disables the network port. Default is  
Eth1 enabled.  
Obtain from DHCP: Acquires IP address, subnet mask,  
hostname and gateway from the DHCP server. (The DHCP  
server may not provide the hostname gateway, depending  
on its setup.) This is the default setting. If you select this  
option, skip to Gateway.  
Obtain from BOOTP: Lets a network node request  
configuration information from a BOOTP "server" node. If  
you select this option, skip to Gateway.  
Specify: Lets you manually assign a static IP address,  
generally provided by the system administrator.  
IP Address (if  
specifying)  
Enter an IP address that will be unique and valid on your  
network. There is no default.  
Enter all IP addresses in dot-quad notation. Do not use  
leading zeros in the fields for dot-quad numbers less than  
100. For example, if your IP address is 172.19.201.28, do  
not enter 028 for the last segment.  
Note: Currently, the SLB branch office manager does not  
support configurations with the same IP subnet on multiple  
interfaces (Ethernet or PPP).  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
Hostname  
If specifying an IP address, enter the network segment on  
which the SLB device resides. There is no default.  
The IP address of the router for this network. There is no  
default.  
The default host name is slbXXXX, where XXXX is the last  
4 characters of the hardware address of Ethernet Port 1.  
There is a 64-character limit (contiguous characters, no  
spaces). The host name becomes the prompt in the  
command line interface.  
Domain  
If desired, specify a domain name (for example,  
support.lantronix.com). The domain name is used for host  
name resolution within the SLB branch office manager. For  
example, if abcd is specified for the SMTP server, and  
mydomain.com is specified for the domain, if abcd cannot  
be resolved, the SLB device attempts to resolve  
abcd.mydomain.com for the SMTP server.  
Date & Time Settings  
Change Date/Time  
Select the checkbox to manually enter the date and time  
at the SLB branch office manager’s location.  
Date  
From the drop-down lists, select the current month, day,  
and year.  
Time  
From the drop-down lists, select the current hour and  
minute.  
Time Zone  
From the drop-down list, select the appropriate time zone.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4: Quick Setup  
Administrator Settings  
Sysadmin  
Password/ Retype  
Password  
To change the password (e.g., from the default) enter a  
password of up to 64 characters.  
6. To save your entries, click the Apply button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4: Quick Setup  
Method #3 Quick Setup on the Command Line Interface  
If the SLB branch office manager does not have an IP address, you can connect a dumb  
terminal or a PC running a terminal emulation program (VT100) to access the command  
line interface. (See Connecting a Terminal on page 25.) If the unit has an IP address, you  
can use SSH or Telnet to connect to the SLB device.  
Note: By default, Telnet is disabled and SSH is enabled. To enable Telnet, use the  
Services web page (see 7: Services), a serial terminal connection, or an SSH connection.  
To complete the command line interface Quick Setup script:  
1. Do one of the following:  
With a serial terminal connection, power up, and when the command line  
displays, press Enter.  
With a network connection, use an SSH program or Telnet program (if Telnet  
has been enabled) to connect to xx.xx.xx.xx (the IP address in dot quad  
notation), and press Enter. You should be at the login prompt.  
2. Enter sysadmin as the user name and press Enter.  
3. Enter PASS as the password and press Enter. The first time you log in, the Quick  
Setup script runs automatically. Normally, the command prompt displays.  
Figure 4-2. Beginning of Quick Setup Script  
Quick Setup will now step you through configuring a few basic settings.  
The current settings are shown in brackets ('[]').  
You can accept the current setting for each question by pressing <return>.  
4. Enter the following information at the prompts:  
Note: To accept a default or to skip an entry that is not required, press  
Enter.  
Configure Eth1  
Select one of the following:  
<1> obtain IP Address from DHCP: The unit will acquire the IP  
address, subnet mask, hostname, and gateway from the DHCP  
server. (The DHCP server may or may not provide the gateway and  
hostname, depending on its setup.) This is the default setting.  
<2> obtain IP Address from BOOTP: Permits a network node  
to request configuration information from a BOOTP "server"  
node.  
<3> static IP Address: Allows you to assign a static IP address  
manually. The IP address is generally provided by the system  
administrator.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4: Quick Setup  
IP Address (if  
specifying)  
An IP address that will be unique and valid on your network and in the  
same subnet as your PC. There is no default.  
If you selected DHCP or BOOTP, this prompt does not display.  
Enter all IP addresses in dot-quad notation. Do not use leading zeros  
in the fields for dot-quad numbers less than 100. For example, if your  
IP address is 172.19.201.28, do not enter 028 for the last segment.  
Note: Configurations with the same IP subnet on multiple interfaces  
(Ethernet or PPP) are not currently supported.  
Subnet Mask  
The subnet mask specifies the network segment on which the branch  
office manager resides. There is no default. If you selected DHCP or  
BOOTP, this prompt does not display.  
Default Gateway  
Hostname  
IP address of the router for this network. There is no default.  
The default host name is slbXXXX, where XXXX is the last 4  
characters of the hardware address of Ethernet Port 1. There is a 64-  
character limit (contiguous characters, no spaces).  
Note: The host name becomes the prompt in the command line  
interface.  
Domain  
If desired, specify a domain name (for example,  
support.lantronix.com). The domain name is used for host name  
resolution within the SLB branch office manager. For example, if abcd  
is specified for the SMTP server, and mydomain.com is specified for  
the domain, if abcd cannot be resolved, the SLB device attempts to  
resolve abcd.mydomain.com for the SMTP server.  
Time Zone  
Date/Time  
If the time zone displayed is incorrect, enter the correct time zone and  
press Enter. If the entry is not a valid time zone, the system guides  
you through selecting a time zone. A list of valid regions and countries  
displays. At the prompts, enter the correct region and country.  
If the date and time displayed are correct, type n and continue. If the  
date and time are incorrect, type y and enter the correct date and time  
in the formats shown at the prompts.  
Sysadmin  
password  
Enter a new sysadmin password.  
After you complete the Quick Setup script, the changes take effect immediately.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4: Quick Setup  
Figure 4-3. Completed Quick Setup  
5. To logout, type logout at the prompt and press Enter.  
Next Step  
After quick starting the SLB branch office manager, you may want to configure other  
settings. You can use the web page or the command line interface for configuration.  
For information about the web and the command line interfaces, go to  
To continue configuring the SLB device, go to 6: Basic Parameters.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5: Web and Command Line Interfaces  
The SLB branch office manager offers three interfaces for configuring the SLB device: a  
command line interface (CLI), a web interface, and an LCD with pushbuttons on the front  
panel. This chapter discusses the web and command line interfaces. (4: Quick Setup  
includes instructions for using the LCD to configure basic network settings.)  
Web Interface  
A web interface allows the system administrator and other authorized users to configure  
and manage the SLB branch office manager using most web browsers (Netscape  
Navigator 6.x and later or Internet Explorer 5.5. and later, with JavaScript enabled). The  
Web Telnet and Web SSH features require Java 1.1 (or later) support in the browser. The  
SLB device provides a secure, encrypted web interface over SSL (secure sockets layer).  
Note: The web server listens for requests on the unencrypted (HTTP) port (port 80) and  
redirects all requests to the encrypted (HTTPS) port (port 443).  
The following figure shows a typical web page:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5: Web and Command Line Interfaces  
Figure 5-1. Web Page Layout  
Port  
Number Bar  
Logout Button  
Icons  
Tabs  
Options  
Help  
Button  
Entry Fields and  
Optons  
Apply Button  
The web page has the following components:  
Tabs: Groups of settings to configure.  
Options: Below each tab are options for specific types of settings.  
Note: Only those options for which the currently logged-in user has rights display.  
Port, Switch, and Power Outlet Bar:  
The E1 and E2 buttons display the Network – Settings page.  
The left-most number buttons allow you to select a port and display its  
settings. Only ports to which the currently logged-in user has rights are  
enabled.  
Below the bar are two options for use with the port buttons. Selecting a port and  
the Configuration option takes you to the Device Port Settings page. Selecting a  
port and the WebSSH option displays the WebSSH window for the device port --  
if Web SSH is enabled, and if SSH is enabled for the device port.  
S (switch) buttons refer to the unmanaged Ethernet switch ports on the back  
of the unit. The firmware does not currently configure or control them.  
Buttons P1 - P4 enable you to select a power outlet and display the Power  
Outlets page with the selected outlet's information highlighted.  
The A and B buttons display the status of the power supplies.  
Entry Fields and Options: Allow you to enter data and select options for the settings.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5: Web and Command Line Interfaces  
Note: For specific instructions on completing the fields on the web pages, see  
Chapters 6 through 12.  
Apply Button: Apply on each web page makes the changes immediately and saves  
them so they will be there when the SLB branch office manager is rebooted.  
Icons: The icon bar above the Main Menu has icons that display the following (in order,  
from left to right)  
:
Home page.  
Information about the SLB device and Lantronix contact information.  
Configuration site map.  
Status of the SLB branch office manager.  
Help Button: Provides online Help for the specific web page.  
Logging in  
Only the system administrator or users with web access rights can log into the web page.  
More than one user at a time can log in, but the same user cannot login more than once.  
To log in to the SLB web interface:  
1. Open a web browser (Netscape Navigator 6.x and later or Internet Explorer 5.5.  
and later).  
2. In the URL field, type https:// followed by the IP address of your SLB branch office  
manager.  
3. To configure the SLB device, use sysadmin as the user name and PASS as the  
password. (These are the default values.)  
Note: The system administrator may have changed the password using one  
of the Quick Setup methods in the previous chapter.  
The Lantronix SLB Quick Setup page displays automatically the first time you log in.  
Subsequently, the Lantronix SLB Home page displays. (If you want to display the  
Quick Setup page again, click Quick Setup on the main menu.)  
Logging off  
To log off the SLB web interface:  
From the main menu, select Logoff. The “SLB logoff complete” message displays.  
Web Page Help  
To view detailed information about an SLB web page:  
Click the Help button to the right of the web page title.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
5: Web and Command Line Interfaces  
Command Line Interface  
A command line interface (CLI) is available for entering all the commands you can use  
with the SLB branch office manager. In this user guide, after each section of instructions  
for using the web interface, you will find the equivalent CLI commands. You can access  
the command line interface using Telnet, SSH, or a serial terminal connection.  
Note: By default, Telnet is disabled and SSH is enabled. To enable Telnet, use the  
Services web page, a serial terminal connection, or an SSH connection.  
The sysadmin user and users with who have full administrative rights have access to the  
complete command set, while all other users have access to a reduced command set  
based on their permissions.  
Logging in  
To log in to the SLB command line interface:  
1. Do one of the following:  
With a serial terminal connection, power up, and when the command line  
displays, press Enter.  
If the SLB branch office manager already has an IP address (assigned  
previously or assigned by DHCP), Telnet (if Telnet has been enabled) or SSH  
to xx.xx.xx.xx (the IP address in dot quad notation) and press Enter. The  
login prompt displays.  
2. To log in as the system administrator for setup and configuration:  
a) Enter sysadmin as the user name and press Enter.  
b) Enter PASS as the password and press Enter. The first time you log in, the  
Quick Setup script runs automatically. Normally, the command prompt  
displays. (If you want to display the Quick Setup script again, use the admin  
quicksetupcommand.)  
Note: The system administrator may have changed the password using  
one of the Quick Setup methods in the previous chapter.  
3. To log in any other user:  
a) Enter your SLB branch office manager user name and press Enter.  
b) Enter your SLB branch office manager password and press Enter.  
Logging out  
To log out of the SLB command line interface:  
1. Type logout and press Enter.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
5: Web and Command Line Interfaces  
Command Syntax  
Commands have the following format:  
<action> <category> <parameter(s)>  
where  
<action>is set, show, connect, admin, diag, pccard, or logout.  
<category>is a group of related parameters whose settings you want to configure or  
view. Examples are ntp, deviceport, and network.  
<parameter(s)> is one or more name-value pairs in one of the following formats:  
User must specify one of the values (aa  
or bb) separated by a vertical line ( | ).  
The values are in all lowercase and must  
be entered exactly as shown. Bold  
indicates a default value.  
<parameter name> <aabb>  
<parameter name> <Value>  
User must specify an appropriate value,  
for example, an IP address. The  
parameter values are in mixed case.  
Square brackets [ ] indicate optional  
parameters.  
Table 5-1. Actions and Category Options  
Category  
Action  
set  
network | ipfilter | routing | datetime | ntp | services |  
nfs | cifs | menu | hostlist | auth | localusers |  
remoteusers | ldap | radius | kerberos | tacacs+ |  
consoleport | deviceport | nis | slcnetwork | command |  
sshkey | password | history | cli | locallog | power  
show  
network | ipfilter | routing | datetime | ntp | services |  
nfs | cifs | menu | hostlist | auth | localusers | nis |  
ldap | radius | kerberos | tacacs+ | consoleport |  
deviceport | locallog | sysstatus | syslog | auditlog |  
portstatus | sysconfig | portcounters | connections |  
slcnetwork | sshkey | history | cli | user | remoteusers |  
power  
connect  
diag  
direct | listen | bidirection | unidirection | terminate  
ping | loopback | traceroute | arp | lookup | netstat |  
perfstat | sendpacket | nettrace | internals  
pccard  
admin  
storage | modem  
reboot | shutdown | ftp | config | firmware | version |  
banner | keypad | quicksetup | web | events | lcd  
logout  
Terminates CLI session.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5: Web and Command Line Interfaces  
Command Line Help  
For general Help and to display the commands to which you have rights, type:  
help  
For general command line Help, type:  
help command line  
For more information about a specific command, type helpfollowed by the command,  
for example:  
help set networkor help admin firmware  
Tips  
Type enough characters to identify the action, category, or parameter name  
uniquely. For parameter values, type the entire value. For example, you can  
shorten:  
set network port 1 state static ipaddr 122.3.10.1 mask  
255.255.0.0  
to  
se net po 1 st static ip 122.3.10.1 ma 255.255.0.0  
Use the Tab key to automatically complete action, category, or parameter  
names. Type a partial name and press Tab either to complete the name if  
only one is possible, or to display the possible names if more than one is  
possible. Following a space after the preceding name, Tab displays all  
possible names.  
Should you make a mistake while typing, backspace by pressing the  
Backspace key and/or the Delete key, depending on how you accessed the  
interface. Both keys work if you use VT100 emulation in your terminal access  
program when connecting to the console port. Use the left and right arrow  
keys to move within a command.  
Use the up and down arrows to scroll through previously entered  
commands. If desired, select one and edit it. You can scroll through up to  
100 previous commands entered in the session.  
To clear an IP address, type 0.0.0.0,or to clear a non-IP address value,  
type CLEAR.  
When the number of lines displayed by a command exceeds the size of the window (the  
default is 25), the command output is halted until the user is ready to continue. To display  
the next line, press Enter, and to display the page, press the space bar. You can override  
the number of lines (or disable the feature altogether) with the set cli command.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5: Web and Command Line Interfaces  
General CLI Commands  
The following commands relate to the CLI itself.  
To configure the current command line session:  
set cli scscommands <enable|disable>  
Allows you to use SCS-compatible commands as shortcuts for executing commands:  
Note: Settings are retained between CLI sessions for local users and users listed in the remote  
users list.  
SCS Commands  
SLB Commands  
info  
'show sysstatus'  
version  
reboot  
poweroff  
listdev  
direct  
listen  
clear  
'admin version'  
'admin reboot'  
'admin shutdown'  
'show deviceport names'  
'connect direct deviceport'  
'connect listen deviceport'  
'set locallog clear'  
telnet  
ssh  
'connect direct telnet'  
'connect direct ssh'  
To set the number of lines displayed by a command:  
set cli terminallines <disable|Number of lines>  
Sets the number of lines in the terminal emulation (screen) for paging through text one  
screenful at a time, if the SLB branch office manager cannot detect the size of the  
terminal automatically.  
To show current CLI settings:  
show cli  
To view the last 100 commands entered in the session:  
show history  
To clear the command history:  
set history clear  
To view the rights of the currently logged-in user:  
show user  
Note: For information about user rights, see 11: User Authentication.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6: Basic Parameters  
This chapter explains how to set the following basic configuration settings for the SLB  
branch office manager using the SLB web interface or the CLI:  
Network parameters that determine how the SLB interacts with the attached  
network  
Firewall and routing  
Date and time  
Note: If you entered some of these settings using a Quick Setup procedure, you  
may update them here.  
Requirements  
If you assign a different IP address from the current one, it must be within a valid range,  
unique to your network, and with the same subnet mask as your workstation.  
To configure the unit, you need the following information:  
IP address: ________. ________ . ________ .________  
Subnet mask: ________. ________ . ________ .________  
Eth1  
Eth2  
IP address (optional): ________. ________ . ________ .________  
Subnet mask (optional): ________. ________ . ________ .________  
Gateway: ________. ________ . ________ .________  
DNS: ________. ________ . ________ .________  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6: Basic Parameters  
To enter settings for one or both network ports:  
1. Click the Network tab and select the Network Settings option. The following page  
displays:  
2. Enter the following information:  
Eth1 and Eth2 Settings  
Note: Configurations with the same IP subnet on multiple interfaces (Ethernet or PPP)  
are not currently supported.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6: Basic Parameters  
Eth 1 and/or Eth 2  
Settings  
Disabled: If selected, disables the network port. Defaults  
are Eth1 and Eth2 enabled.  
Obtain from DHCP: Acquires IP address, subnet mask,  
hostname and gateway from the DHCP server. (The DHCP  
server may not provide the hostname gateway, depending  
on its setup.) This is the default setting. If you select this  
option, skip to Gateway.  
Obtain from BOOTP: Lets a network node request  
configuration information from a BOOTP "server" node. If  
you select this option, skip to Gateway.  
Specify: Lets you manually assign a static IP address,  
generally provided by the system administrator.  
IP Address (if  
specifying)  
Enter an IP address that will be unique and valid on your  
network. There is no default.  
Enter all IP addresses in dot-quad notation. Do not use  
leading zeros in the fields for dot-quad numbers less than  
100. For example, if your IP address is 172.19.201.28, do  
not enter 028 for the last segment.  
Note: Currently, the SLB branch office manager does not  
support configurations with the same IP subnet on multiple  
interfaces (Ethernet or PPP).  
Subnet Mask  
If specifying an IP address, enter the network segment on  
which the SLB device resides. There is no default.  
Eth 1 and/or Eth2  
IPv6 Address  
Address of the port in IPv6 format.  
Note: The SLB branch office manager supports IPv6  
connections for a limited set of services: the web, SSH,  
and Telnet.  
IPv6 addresses are written as 8 sets of 4-digit hexadecimal  
numbers separated by colons. There are several rules for  
modifying the address. For example,  
1234:0BCD:1D67:0000:0000:8375:BADD:0057 may be  
shortened to 1234:BCD:1D67::8375:BADD:57.  
Eth 1 and/or Eth2  
Mode  
Select the direction (full duplex or half-duplex) and speed  
(10 or 100Mbit) of data transmission. The default is Auto,  
which allows the Ethernet port to auto-negotiate the speed  
and duplex with the hardware endpoint to which it is  
connected.  
Eth 1 and/or Eth2  
Multicast  
Displays the multicast address of the Ethernet port.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6: Basic Parameters  
Gateway  
Default  
IP address of the router for this network.  
If this has not been set manually, any gateway acquired by  
DHCP for Eth1 or Eth2 displays.  
All network traffic that matches the Eth1 IP address and  
subnet mask is sent out Eth1. All network traffic that  
matches the Eth2 IP address and subnet mask is sent out  
Eth 2.  
If you set a default gateway, any network traffic that does  
not match Eth1 or Eth2 is sent to the default gateway for  
routing.  
DHCP-Acquired  
Gateway acquired by DHCP for Eth1 or Eth2.  
(view only)  
GPRS-Acquired  
Displays the IP address of the router if it has been  
automatically assigned by General Packet Radio Service  
(GPRS).  
(view only)  
Precedence  
Indicates whether the gateway acquired by DHCP or the  
default gateway takes precedence. The default is DHCP  
Gateway. If the DHCP Gateway is selected and both Eth1  
and Eth2 are configured for DHCP, the SLB branch office  
manager gives precedence to the Eth1 gateway.  
Alternate  
An alternate IP address of the router for this network, to be  
used if an IP address usually accessible through the  
default gateway fails to return one or more pings.  
IP Address to Ping  
IP address to ping to determine whether to use the  
alternate gateway.  
Ethernet Port to  
Ping  
Ethernet port to use for the ping.  
Number of seconds between pings  
Delay between  
Pings  
Number of Failed  
Pings  
Number of pings that fail before the SLB device uses the  
alternate gateway.  
Enable IP  
Forwarding  
IP forwarding enables network traffic received on one  
interface (Eth1, Eth2, or an external/PC Card modem  
attached to the SLB branch office manager with an active  
PPP connection) to be transferred out another interface  
(any of the above). The default behavior (if IP forwarding is  
disabled) is for network traffic to be received but not routed  
to another destination.  
Enabling IP forwarding is required if you enable Network  
Address Translation (NAT) for any device port modem or  
PC Card/ISDN modem. IP forwarding allows a user  
accessing the SLB branch office manager over a modem  
to access the network connected to Eth1 or Eth2.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6: Basic Parameters  
Hostname & Name Servers  
Hostname  
The default host name is slbXXXX, where XXXX is the last  
4 characters of the hardware address of Ethernet Port 1.  
There is a 64-character limit (contiguous characters, no  
spaces). The host name becomes the prompt in the  
command line interface.  
Domain  
If desired, specify a domain name (for example,  
support.lantronix.com). The domain name is used for host  
name resolution within the SLB branch office manager. For  
example, if abcd is specified for the SMTP server, and  
mydomain.com is specified for the domain, if abcd cannot  
be resolved, the SLB device attempts to resolve  
abcd.mydomain.com for the SMTP server.  
DNS Servers  
DNS Servers  
#1 - #3  
Configure up to three name servers. #1 is required if you  
choose to configure DNS (Domain Name Server) servers.  
The first three DNS servers acquired via DHCP through  
Eth1 and/or Eth2 display automatically.  
DHCP-Acquired DNS Servers  
#1 - #3  
Displays the IP address of the name servers if  
automatically assigned by DHCP.  
GPRS-Acquired DNS Servers  
#1 - #3  
Displays the IP address of the name servers if  
automatically assigned by General Packet Radio Service  
(GPRS).  
TCP Keepalive Parameters  
Start Probes  
Number of seconds the SLB branch office manager waits  
after the last transmission before sending the first probe to  
determine whether a TCP session is still alive. The default  
is 600 seconds (10 minutes).  
Number of Probes  
Interval  
Number of probes the SLB device sends before closing a  
session. The default is 5.  
The number of seconds the SLB branch office manager  
waits between probes. The default is 60 seconds.  
3. To save your entries, click the Apply button. Apply makes the changes  
immediately and saves them so they will be there when the SLB branch office  
manager is rebooted.  
Ethernet Counters  
The Network-Settings page displays statistics for each of the SLB Ethernet ports since  
boot-up. The system automatically updates them.  
Note: For Ethernet statistics for a smaller time period, use the diag perfstat  
command.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6: Basic Parameters  
Network Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure Ethernet port 1 or 2:  
set network port <1|2> <parameters>  
Parameters:  
mode <auto|10mbit-half|100mbit-half|  
10mbit-full|100mbit-full>  
state <dhcp|bootp|static|disable>  
[ipaddr <IP Address> mask <Mask>]  
[ipv6addr <IP v6 Address|Prefix>]  
To configure up to three DNS servers:  
set network dns <1|2|3> ipaddr <IP Address>  
To set the default and alternate network gateways:  
set network gateway <parameters>  
Parameters:  
default <IP Address>  
precedence <dhcp|gprs|default>  
alternate <IP Address>  
pingip <IP Address>  
ethport <1 or 2>  
pingdelay <1-250 seconds>  
failedpings <1-25>  
The alternate gateway is used if an IP address usually accessible through the default  
gateway fails to return one or more pings.  
To set the SLB host name and domain name:  
set network host <Hostname> [domain <Domain Name>]  
To set TCP Keepalive and IP Forwarding network parameters:  
set network <parameters>  
Parameters:  
interval <1-99999 Seconds>  
ipforwarding <enable|disable>  
probes <Number of Probes>  
startprobes <1-99999 Seconds>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6: Basic Parameters  
To view all network settings:  
show network all  
To view Ethernet port settings and counters:  
show network port <1|2>  
To view DNS settings:  
show network dns  
To view gateway settings:  
show network gateway  
To view the host name of the SLB device:  
show network host  
IP Filter  
IP filters (also called a rule set) act as a firewall to allow or deny individual or a range of  
IP addresses, ports, and protocols. When a network connection is configured to use an  
IP filter, all network traffic through that connection is compared, in order, to the rules of  
that filter. Network traffic may be allowed to pass, it may be dropped (without notice), or it  
may be rejected (sends back an error packet) depending upon the rules of that filter rule  
set.  
The administrator uses the Network – IP Filter page to view, add, edit, delete, and map IP  
filters,  
Warning: IP filters configuration is a feature for advanced users. Adding and  
enabling IP filter sets incorrectly can disable your SLB branch office manager.  
Viewing IP Filters  
You can view a list of filters and a table showing how each filter is mapped to an  
interface.  
To view a list of IP filters:  
1. Click the Network tab and select the IP Filter option. The following page displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6: Basic Parameters  
Enabling IP Filters  
On the IP Filter page, you can enable all filters or disable all filters.  
Note: There is no way to enable or disable individual filters.  
To enable IP filters:  
1. Enter the following:  
Enable IP Filter  
Select the Enable IP Filter checkbox to enable all filters,  
or clear the checkbox to disable all filters. Disabled by  
default.  
Packets Dropped  
(view only)  
Displays the number of data packets that the filter ignored  
(did not respond to).  
Packets Rejected  
(view only)  
Displays the number of data packets that the filter sent a  
“rejected” response to.  
Test Timer  
Timer for testing IP Filter rulesets. Select No to disable the  
timer. Select Yes, minutes (1-120) to enable the timer and  
enter the number of minutes the timer should run. The  
timer automatically disables the IP Filters when the time  
expires.  
Time Remaining  
(view only)  
Indicates how many minutes are left on the timer before it  
expires and IP Filters are disabled.  
Configuring IP Filters  
The administrator can add, edit, delete, and map IP filters.  
Note: A configured filter has no effect until it is mapped to a network interface. See  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6: Basic Parameters  
To add an IP filter:  
1. On the IP Filter page, click the Add Ruleset button. The following page displays:  
2. Enter the following  
Ruleset Name  
Name that identifies a filter; may be composed of letters,  
numbers, and hyphens only. (The name cannot start with a  
hyphen.)  
Example: FILTER-2  
Rule Parameters  
IP Address  
Specify a single IP address to act as a filter.  
Example: 172.19.220.64 – this specific IP address only  
Subnet Mask  
Protocol  
Specify a subnet mask to act as a filter.  
Example: 255.255.0.0  
From the drop-down list, select the type of protocol through  
which the filter will operate. The default setting is All.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6: Basic Parameters  
Port Range  
Enter a range of destination TCP or UDP port numbers to  
be tested. An entry is required for TCP, TCP New, TCP  
Established, and UDP, and is not allowed for other  
protocols. Separate multiple ports with commas. Separate  
ranges of ports by colons.  
Examples:  
22 – filter on port 22 only  
23,64,80 – filter on ports 23, 64 and 80  
23:64,80,143:150 – filter on ports 23 through 64, port 80  
and ports 143 through 150  
Action  
Select whether to drop, reject, or allow communications for  
the specified IP address, subnet mask, protocol, and port  
range. Drop ignores the packet with no notification. Reject  
ignores the packet and sends back an error message. Allow  
permits the packet through the filter.  
Generate rule to  
allow service  
You may wish to “punch holes” in your filter set for a  
particular protocol or service.  
For instance, if you have configured your NIS server and  
wish to create an opening in your filter set, select the NIS  
option and click the Add Rule button. This entry adds a new  
rule to your filter set using the NIS -configured IP address.  
Other services and protocols added automatically generate  
the necessary rule to allow their use.  
3. Click the right arrow button to add the new rule to the bottom of the Rules list box  
on the right.  
4. To remove a rule from the filter set, highlight that line and click the left arrow. The  
rule populates the rule definition fields, allowing you to make minor changes before  
reinserting the rule. To clear the definition fields, click the Clear button.  
5. To change the order of priority of the rules in the list box, select the rule to move  
and use the up or down arrow buttons on the right side of the filter list box.  
6. To save, click the Apply button. The new filter displays in the menu tree.  
Note: To add another new filter rule set, click the Back to IP Filter link to return to the  
IP Filter page.  
Updating an IP Filter  
The administrator can update an IP filter rule set.  
1. On the IP Filter page, select the IP filter ruleset to be edited and click the Edit  
Ruleset button. The IP Filter Ruleset page displays.  
2. Edit the information as desired and click the Apply button.  
Deleting an IP Filter  
The administrator can delete an IP filter rule set.  
1. On the IP Filter page, select the IP filter ruleset to be deleted and click the Delete  
button.  
Mapping a Rule Set  
The administrator can assign an IP Filter Rule Set to a network interface (Ethernet  
interface), a modem connected to a Device Port, or a PC Card modem.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
6: Basic Parameters  
To map a rule set to a network interface:  
1. On the IP Filter page, select the IP filter rule set to be mapped.  
2. From the Interface drop-down list, select the interface and click the Map Ruleset  
button. The Interface and rule set display in the IP Filter Mappings table.  
To delete a mapping:  
1. On the IP Filter page, select the mapping from the list and click the Delete  
Mappings button. The mapping no longer displays.  
2. Click the Apply button.  
IP Filter Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To enable or disable IP filtering for incoming network traffic:  
set ipfilter state  
To set IP filter mapping:  
set ipfilter mapping <parameters>  
Parameters:  
ethernet <1|2> state <disable>  
ethernet <1|2> state <enable> ruleset <Ruleset Name>  
deviceport <1..48> state <disable>  
deviceport <1..48> state <enable> ruleset <Ruleset  
Name>  
pccardslot <upper|lower> state <disable>  
pccardslot <upper|lower> state <enable> ruleset  
<Ruleset Name>  
To set IP filter rules:  
set ipfilter rules <parameters>  
Parameters:  
add <Ruleset Name>  
delete <Ruleset Name>  
edit <Ruleset Name> <Edit Parameters>  
Edit Parameters:  
append  
insert <Rule Number>  
replace <Rule Number>  
delete <Rule Number>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6: Basic Parameters  
Routing  
The SLB branch office manager allows you to define static routes and, for networks using  
Routing Information Protocol (RIP)-capable routes, to enable the RIP protocol to  
configure the routes dynamically.  
To configure routing settings:  
1. Click the Network tab and select the Routing option. The following page displays:  
2. Enter the following:  
Dynamic Routing  
Enable RIP  
Select to enable Dynamic Routing Information Protocol  
(RIP) to assign routes automatically. Disabled by default.  
RIP Version  
Select the RIP version. The default is 2.  
Static Routing  
Enable Static  
Routing  
Select to assign the routes manually. The system  
administrator usually provides the routes. Disabled by  
default.  
To add a static route, enter the IP Address, Subnet  
Mask, and Gateway for the route and click the  
Add/Edit Route button. The route displays in the Static  
Routes table. You can add up to 64 static routes.  
To edit a static route, select the radio button to the right  
of the route, change the IP Address, Subnet Mask,  
and Gateway fields as desired, and click the Add/Edit  
Route button.  
To delete a static route, select the radio button to the  
right of the route and click the Delete Route button.  
3. Click the Apply button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6: Basic Parameters  
Note: To display the routing table, click the IP Routes Report link. The  
Status/Reports page displays. To view the report, select the IP Routes checkbox and  
click Generate Report.  
Equivalent Routing Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure static or dynamic routing:  
set routing [parameters]  
Parameters:  
rip <enable|disable>  
route <1-64> ipaddr <IP Address> mask <Netmask>  
gateway <IP Address>  
static <enable|disable>  
version <1|2|both>  
Note: To delete a static route, set the IP address, mask, and gateway parameters to 0.0.0.0.  
To set the routing table to display IP addresses (disable) or the corresponding host  
names (enable):  
show routing [resolveip <enable|disable>] [email <Email Address>]  
Note: You can optionally email the displayed information.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7: Services  
System Logging and Other Services  
Use the Services page to:  
Configure the amount of data sent to the logs.  
Enable or disable SSH and Telnet logins.  
Enable a Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) agent.  
Note: The SLB branch office manager supports both MIB-II (as defined by RFC  
1213) and a private enterprise MIB. MIB definition files for the private enterprise  
MIB are downloadable at http://www.lantronix.com/support/downloads/. The  
private enterprise MIB provides read-only access to all statistics and configurable  
items provided by the SLB. It provides read-write access to a select set of  
functions for controlling the SLB and device ports. See the MIB definition file for  
details.  
Identify a Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) server.  
Enable or disable SSH and Telnet logins.  
Configure an audit log.  
View the status of and manage the SLB branch office managers on the Secure  
Lantronix Network.  
Set the date and time.  
SSH/Telnet/Logging  
To configure SSH, Telnet, and Logging settings:  
1. Click the Services tab and select the SSH/Telnet /Logging option. The following  
page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7: Services  
2. Enter the following settings:  
System Logging  
In the System Logging section, select one of the following alert levels from the drop-  
down list for each message category:  
Off: Disables this type of logging.  
Info: Saves informative message, in addition to warning and error messages.  
Warning: Saves message output from a condition that may be cause for concern,  
in addition to error messages. This is the default for all message types.  
Error: Saves messages that are output because of an error.  
Debug: Saves extraneous detail that may be helpful in tracking down a problem,  
in addition to information, warning, and error messages.  
Network Level  
Services  
Messages concerning the network activity, for example  
about Ethernet and routing.  
Messages concerning services such as SNMP and  
SMTP.  
Authentication  
Device Ports  
Diagnostics  
General  
Messages concerning user authentication.  
Messages concerning device ports and connections.  
Messages concerning system status and problems.  
Any message not in the categories above.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
Remote Servers  
(#1 and #2)  
IP address of the remote server(s) where system logs  
are stored.  
The system log is always saved to local SLB storage. It  
is retained through SLB branch office manager reboots  
for files up to 200K. Saving the system log to a server  
that supports remote logging services (see RFC 3164)  
allows the administrator to save the complete system  
log history.  
SSH  
Enable Logins  
Enables or disables SSH logins to the SLB branch  
office manager to allow users to access the CLI using  
SSH. Enabled by default.  
This setting does not control SSH access to individual  
for information on enabling SSH access to individual  
ports.)  
Most system administrators enable SSH logins, which  
is the preferred method of accessing the system.  
Web SSH  
Timeout  
Enables or disables the ability to access the SLB  
command Iine interface or device ports (connect direct)  
through the Web SSH window. Disabled by default.  
If you enable SSH logins, you can cause an idle  
connection to disconnect after a specified number of  
minutes. Select Yes and enter a value of from 1 to 30  
minutes.  
Note: You must reboot the unit before a change will  
take effect.  
SSH Port  
Allows you to change the SSH login port to a different  
value in the range of 1 - 65535. The default is 22.  
Note: You must reboot the unit before a change will  
take effect.  
SSH V1 Logins  
Enables or disables SSH version 1 connections to the  
SLB branch office manager. Enabled by default.  
Note: Disabling SSH V1 blocks Web SSH CLI and Web  
SSH to device port connections on the SLB Network  
page. Also, you must reboot the SLB device before a  
change will take effect.  
Telnet  
Enable Logins  
Enables or disables Telnet logins to the SLB branch  
office manager to allow users to access the CLI using  
Telnet. Disabled by default.  
This setting does not control Telnet access to individual  
for information on enabling Telnet access to individual  
ports.)  
You may want to keep this option disabled for security  
reasons.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
Web Telnet  
Timeout  
Enables or disables the ability to access the SLB  
command Iine interface or device ports (connect direct)  
through the Web Telnet window. Disabled by default.  
If you enable Telnet logins, you can cause an idle  
connection to disconnect after a specified number of  
minutes. Select Yes and enter a value of from 1 to 30  
minutes.  
Note: You must reboot the unit before a change will  
take effect.  
Audit Log  
Enable Log  
Select to save a history of all configuration changes in  
a circular log. Disabled by default. The audit log is  
saved through SLB device reboots.  
Size  
The log has a default maximum size of 50 Kbytes  
(approximately 500 entries). You can set the maximum  
size of the log from 1 to 500 Kbytes.  
Include CLI  
Commands  
Select to cause the audit log to include the CLI  
commands that have been executed. Disabled by  
default.  
Include In System  
Log  
If enabled, the contents of the audit log are added to  
the system log (under the General/Info category/level).  
Disabled by default.  
SMTP  
Server  
IP address of your network’s Simple Mail Transfer  
Protocol (SMTP) relay server.  
Phone Home  
Enable  
If enabled, the SLB branch office manager will attempt  
to phone home every hour until it has contacted an  
SLM management appliance and provided it with its  
configuration.  
IP Address  
IP address of the SLM management appliance.  
Date and time of last connection attempt.  
Last Attempt  
(view only)  
Results  
Indicates whether the attempt was successful.  
(view only)  
3. To save, click the Apply button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
SNMP  
Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is a set of protocols for managing  
complex networks.  
1. Click the Services tab and select the SNMP option. The following page displays:  
2. Enter the following:  
Enable Agent  
Enables or disables SNMP agent, which allows read-  
only access to the system. Disabled by default.  
Enable Traps  
Traps are notifications of certain critical events.  
Disabled by default. This feature is applicable when  
SNMP is enabled. Examples of traps that the SLB  
branch office manager sends include:  
Ethernet Port Link Up  
Ethernet Port Link Down  
Authentication Failure  
SLB Booted  
SLB Shutdown  
Device Port Logging  
Power Supply Status  
Sysadmin user password changed  
The SLB branch office manager sends the traps to the  
host identified in the NMS field.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7: Services  
NMS  
When SNMP is enabled, an NMS (Network  
Management System) acts as a central server,  
requesting and receiving SNMP-type information from  
any computer using SNMP. The NMS can request  
information from the SLB branch office manager and  
receive traps from the SLB device. Enter the IP  
address of the NMS server. Required if you selected  
Enable Traps.  
Location  
Contact  
Physical location of the SLB branch office manager  
(optional). Useful for managing the SLB device using  
SNMP. Up to 20 characters.  
Description of the person responsible for maintaining  
the SLB branch office manager, for example, a name  
(optional). Up to 20 characters.  
Alarm Delay  
Number of seconds delay between outgoing SNMP  
traps.  
Communities  
Trap  
The trap used for outgoing generic and enterprise  
traps. Traps sent with the Event trigger mechanism still  
use the trap community specified with the Event action.  
The default is public.  
Read-Only  
Read-Write  
A string that acts like a password for an SNMP  
manager to access the read-only data the SLB SNMP  
agent provides. The default is public.  
A string that acts like a password for an SNMP  
manager to access the read-only data the SLB SNMP  
agent provides and to modify data where permitted.  
The default is private.  
Version 3  
Security  
Levels of security available with SNMP v. 3.  
No Auth/No Encrypt: No authentication or encryption.  
Auth/No Encrypt: Authentication but no encryption.  
(default)  
Auth/Encrypt: Authentication and encryption.  
Auth with  
For Auth/No Encryp or Auth/Encrypt, the  
authentication method:  
MD5: Message-Digest algorithm 5 (default)  
SHA: Secure Hash Algorithm  
Encrypt with  
Encryption standard to use:  
DES: Data Encryption Standard (default)  
AES: Advanced Encryption Standard  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
V3 Read-Only User  
User Name  
SNMP v3 is secure and requires user-based  
authorization to access SLB MIB objects. Enter a user  
ID. The default is snmpuser. Up to 20 characters.  
V3  
Password for a user with read-only authority to use to  
Password/Retype  
Password  
access SNMP v3. The default is SNMPPASS. Up to 20  
characters.  
Passphrase/  
Retype  
Passphrase associated with the password for a user  
with read-only authority. Up to 20 characters.  
Passphrase  
V3 Read-Write User  
User Name  
SNMP v3 is secure and requires user-based  
authorization to access SLB MIB objects. Enter a user  
ID for users with read-write authority. The default is  
snmprwuser. Up to 20 characters.  
V3  
Password for the user with read-write authority to use  
to access SNMP v3. The default is SNMPRWPASS. Up  
to 20 characters.  
Password/Retype  
Password  
Passphrase/  
Retype  
Passphrase associated with the password for a user  
with read-write authority. Up to 20 characters.  
Passphrase  
3. To save, click the Apply button.  
SNMP, SSH, Telnet, and Logging Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure services (system logging, SSH and Telnet access, SSH and Telnet  
timeout, SNMP agent, email (SMTP) server, and audit log):  
set services <one or more services parameters>  
Parameters:  
alarmdelay <1-6000 Seconds>  
auditlog <enable|disable>  
auditsize <Size in Kbytes>  
Range is 1-500 Kbytes.  
authlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
clicommands <enable|disable>  
contact <Admin contact info>  
devlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
diaglog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
genlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
includesyslog <enable|disable>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7: Services  
location <Physical Location>  
netlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
nms <IP Address or Name>  
phonehome <enable|disable>  
phoneip <IP Address>  
portssh <TCP Port>  
rocommunity <Read-Only Community Name>  
rwcommunity <Read-Write Community Name>  
servlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
smtpserver <IP Address or Hostname>  
snmp <enable|disable>  
ssh <enable|disable>  
syslogserver1 <IP Address or Name>  
syslogserver2 <IP Address or Name>  
telnet <enable|disable>  
timeoutssh <disable or 1-30>  
timeouttelnet <disable or 1-30>  
traps <enable|disable>  
trapcommunity <Trap Community>  
v1ssh <enable|disable>  
v3user <V3 RO User>  
v3password <V3 RO User Password>  
v3phrase <V3 RO User Passphrase>  
v3rwuser <V3 RW User>  
v3rwpassword <V3 RW User Password>  
v3rwphrase <V3 RW User Passphrase>  
v3security <noauth|auth|authencrypt>  
v3auth <md5|sha>  
v3encrypt <des|aes>  
v3password <Password for v3 auth>  
v3user <User for v3 auth>  
webssh <enable|disable>  
webtelnet <enable|disable>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
To view current services:  
show services  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
NFS and SMB/CIFS  
Use the NFS & SMB/CIFS page if you want to save configuration and logging data onto a  
remote NFS server, or export configuration and logging data by means of an exported  
CIFS share.  
Mounting an NFS shared directory on a remote network server onto a local SLB directory  
enables the SLB branch office manager to store device port logging data on that network  
server. This configuration avoids possible limitations in the amount of disk space on the  
SLB device available for the logging file(s). You may also save SLB configurations on the  
network server.  
Similarly, use SMB/CIFS (Server Message Block/Common Internet File System),  
Microsoft’s file-sharing protocol, to export a directory on the SLB branch office manager  
as an SMB/CIFS share. The SLB device exports a single read-write CIFS share called  
"public," with two subdirectories:  
The logsdirectory, which contains the system logs and the device port local  
buffers (see System Logs on page 190) and is read-only.  
The configdirectory, which contains saved configurations and is read-write.  
The share allows users to access the contents of the directory or map the directory onto  
a Windows computer. Users can also access the device port local buffers from the CIFS  
To configure NFS and SMB/CIFS:  
1. Click the Services tab and select the NFS/CIFS option. The following page  
displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7: Services  
2. Enter the following for up to three directories:  
NFS Mounts  
Remote Directory  
The remote NFS share directory in the format:  
nfs_server_hostname or ipaddr:/exported/path  
Local Directory  
The local directory on the SLB branch office  
manager on which to mount the remote directory.  
The SLB device creates the local directory  
automatically.  
Read-Write  
Mount  
If enabled, indicates that the SLB branch office  
manager can write files to the remote directory. If  
you plan to log port data or save configurations to  
this directory, you must enable this option.  
Select the checkbox to enable the SLB device to  
mount the file to the NFS server. Disabled by  
default.  
3. Enter the following:  
SMB/CIFS Share  
Share SMB/CIFS  
directory  
Select the checkbox to enable the SLB branch  
office manager to export an SMB/CIFS share  
called “public.” Disabled by default.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
Network Interfaces  
Select the network ports from which the share can  
be seen. The default is for the share to be visible  
on both network ports.  
CIFS User  
Password/Retype  
Password  
Only one user special username (cifsuser) can  
access the CIFS share. Enter the CIFS user  
password in both password fields. The default  
user password is CIFSPASS.  
More than one user can access the share with the  
cifsuser user name and password at the same  
time.  
Workgroup  
The Windows workgroup to which the SLB branch  
office manager belongs. Every PC exporting a  
CIFS share must belong to a workgroup. Can  
have up to 15 characters.  
4. To save, click the Apply button.  
NFS and SMB/CIFS Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To mount a remote NFS share:  
set nfs mount <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
locdir <Directory>  
mount <enable|disable>  
remdir <Remote NFS Directory>  
rw <enable|disable>  
Enables read/write access to remote directory.  
Note: The remdirand locdir parameters are required, but if you specified them previously,  
you do not need to provide them again.  
To unmount a remote NFS share:  
set nfs unmount <1|2|3>  
To view NFS share settings:  
show nfs  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7: Services  
To configure the SMB/CIFS share, which contains the system and device port logs:  
set cifs <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
eth1 <enable|disable>  
eth2 <enable|disable>  
state <enable|disable>  
workgroup <Windows workgroup>  
Note: The admin config command saves SLB configurations on the SMB/CIFS share.  
To change the password for the SMB/CIFS share login (default is cifsuser):  
set cifs password  
To view SMB/CIFS settings:  
show cifs  
Secure Lantronix Network  
Use the Secure Lantronix Network option to view and manage SLC console manager  
and Spiders on the local subnet.  
Note: Status and statistics shown on the web interface represent a snapshot in  
time. To see the most recent data, reload the web page.  
To view and manage SLB branch office managers and Lantronix® Spiders™ on the  
local network:  
1. Click the Services tab and select the Secure Lantronix Network option. The  
following page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7: Services  
2. To manage a secure IT management device, click its IP Address. A separate  
browser page takes the user to the web interface for the selected Secure IT  
management device (login required).  
3. For SLM management appliances, if SSH or Telnet is enabled for the device (to the  
CLI) or for a device port and you want to access the device or device port:  
a) Click the View link in the Telnet/SSH to Device Ports or CLI column. The  
following page displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
Above the table, the Telnet to the CLI Enabled and SSH to the CLI Enabled fields  
indicate whether the unit has been set for Telnet or SSH access to the CLI. The table  
page lists all of the unit’s device ports (if applicable), indicates whether they are  
Telnet enabled or SSH enabled, and lists their Telnet and SSH port numbers.  
Note: For the links to work, you must enable Web Telnet or Web SSH for the  
secure IT management unit.  
b) To open a Telnet session to the CLI, click Yes in the Telnet to the CLI  
Enabled field above the table.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
c) To open a Telnet session to a specific device port, click the Yes link in the  
Telnet Enabled column.  
d) To open an SSH session to the CLI, click Yes in the SSH to the CLI Enabled  
field above the table.  
e) To open an SSH session to a specific device port, click the Yes link in the SSH  
Enabled column.  
To configure how secure IT management devices are searched for on the network:  
1. Click the Search Options link on the top right of the Secure Lantronix Network  
page. The following web page displays:  
2. Enter the following:  
Secure Lantronix  
Network Search  
Select the type of search you want to conduct.  
Local Subnet performs a broadcast to detect secure IT  
management devices on the local subnet.  
Manually Entered IP Address List provides a list of IP  
addresses that may not respond to a broadcast because of  
how the network is configured.  
The default is Both.  
IP Address  
If you selected Manually Entered IP Address List or  
Both, enter the IP address of the secure IT management  
device you want to find and manage.  
3. If you entered an IP address, click the Add IP Address button. The IP address  
displays in the IP Address List.  
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for each IP address you want to add.  
5. To delete an IP address from the IP Address List, select the address and click the  
Delete IP Address button.  
6. Click the Apply button. When the confirmation message displays, click Secure  
Lantronix Network on the main menu. The Secure Lantronix Network page  
displays the secure IT management devices resulting from the search. You can  
now manage these devices.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
Secure Lantronix Network Commands  
The following commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page  
entries described above.  
To detect and view all SLB branch office manager or user-defined IP addresses on  
the local network:  
set slcnetwork <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
add <IP Address>  
delete <IP Address>  
search <localsubnet|ipaddrlist|both>  
To detect and display all secure IT managers and Spiders on the local network:  
show slcnetwork [ipaddrlist <all|Address Mask>]  
Note: Without the ipaddrlistparameter, the command searches the network  
according to the search setting. With the ipaddrlistparameter, the command  
displays a sorted list of all IP addresses or displays the IP addresses that match  
the mask (for example, 172.19.255.255 would display all IP addresses that start  
with 172.19).  
Date and Time  
You can specify the current date, time, and time zone at the SLB branch office manager’s  
location (default), or the SLB device can use NTP to synchronize with other NTP devices  
on your network.  
To set the local date, time, and time zone:  
1. Click the Services tab and select the Date & Time option. The following page  
displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
7: Services  
2. Enter the following:  
Change  
Select the checkbox to manually enter the date and time at  
Date/Time  
the SLB branch office manager’s location.  
Date  
From the drop-down lists, select the current month, day,  
and year.  
Time  
From the drop-down lists, select the current hour and  
minute.  
Time Zone  
From the drop-down list, select the appropriate time zone.  
3. To save, click the Apply button.  
To synchronize the SLB branch office manager with a remote timeserver using  
NTP:  
1. Enter the following:  
Enable NTP  
Select the checkbox to enable NTP synchronization.  
NTP is disabled by default.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7: Services  
Synchronize via  
Select one of the following:  
Broadcast from NTP Server: Enables the SLB  
branch office manager to accept time information  
periodically transmitted by the NTP server. This is  
the default if you enable NTP.  
Poll NTP Server: Enables the SLB device to query  
the NTP Server for the correct time. If you select this  
option, complete one of the following:  
Local: Select this option if the NTP servers are  
on a local network, and enter the IP address of  
up to three NTP servers. This is the default, and  
it is highly recommended.  
Public: Select this option if you want to use a  
public NTP server, and select the address of the  
NTP server from the drop-down list. This is not  
recommended because of the high load on many  
public NTP servers. All servers in the drop-down  
list are stratum-2 servers. (See www.ntp.org for  
more information.)  
Each public NTP server has its own usage rules -  
-please refer to the appropriate web site before  
using one. Our listing them here is to provide  
easy configuration but does not indicate any  
permission for use.  
2. To save, click the Apply button.  
Date and Time Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To set the local date, time, and local time zone (one parameter at a time):  
set datetime <one date/time parameter>  
Parameters:  
date <MMDDYYhhmm[ss]>  
timezone <Time Zone>  
Note: If you type an invalid time zone, the system guides you through the  
process of selecting a time zone.  
To view the local date, time, and time zone:  
show datetime  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7: Services  
To synchronize the SLB branch office manager with a remote time server using  
NTP:  
set ntp <one or more ntp parameters>  
Parameters:  
localserver1 <IP Address or Hostname>  
localserver2 <IP Address or Hostname>  
localserver3 <IP Address or Hostname>  
poll <local|public>  
publicserver <IP Address or Hostname>  
state <enable|disable>  
sync <broadcast|poll>  
To view NTP settings:  
show ntp  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
This chapter describes how to configure and use an SLB branch office manager device  
port connected to an external device, such as a server or a modem. The next chapter,  
10: Connections, describes how to use the Connections web page to connect external  
devices and outbound network connections (such as Telnet or SSH) in various  
configurations. The Console Port page allows you to configure the console port, if  
desired.  
Connection Methods  
A user can connect to a device port in one of the following ways:  
1. Telnet or SSH to the Eth1 or Eth2 IP address, or connect to the console port, and  
log in to the command line interface. At the command line interface, issue the  
connect director connect listencommands.  
2. If Telnet is enabled for a device port, Telnet to <Eth1 IP address>:< telnet port  
number> or <Eth2 IP address>:<telnet port number>, where telnet port number is  
uniquely assigned for each device port.  
3. If SSH is enabled for a device port, SSH to <Eth1 IP address>:<ssh port number>  
or <Eth2 IP address>:<ssh port number>, where ssh port number is uniquely  
assigned for each device port.  
4. If TCP is enabled for a device port, establish a raw TCP connection to <Eth1 IP  
address>:<tcp port number> or <Eth2 IP address>:<tcp port number>, where tcp  
port number is uniquely assigned for each device port.  
5. If a device port has an IP address assigned to it, you can Telnet, SSH, or establish  
a raw TCP connection to the IP address. For Telnet and SSH, use the default TCP  
port number (23 and 22, respectively) to connect to the device port. For raw TCP,  
use the TCP port number defined for TCP In to the device port on the Device Ports  
6. Connect a terminal or a terminal emulation program directly to the device port. If  
logins are enabled, the user is prompted for a username and password and logs in  
to the command line interface.  
For #2, #3, #4, #5, and #6, if logins or authentication are not enabled, the user is directly  
connected to the device port with no authentication.  
For #1 and #6, if logins are enabled, the user is authenticated first, and then logged into  
the command line interface. The user login determines permissions for accessing device  
ports.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
8: Device Ports  
Permissions  
There are three types of permissions:  
Direct (or data) mode: The user can interact with and monitor the device port  
(connect directcommand).  
Listen mode: The user can only monitor the device port (connect listen  
command).  
Clear mode: The user can clear the contents of the device port buffer (set  
locallog <port> clear buffer command).  
The administrator and users with local user rights may assign individual port permissions  
to local users. The administrator and users with remote authentication rights assign port  
access to users authenticated by NIS, RADIUS, LDAP, Kerberos and TACACS+.  
Device Status  
The Device Status page displays the status of the SLB branch office manager's ports, PC  
card slots and power outlets.  
1. Click the Devices tab and select the Device Status option. The following page  
displays:  
Global Port Settings  
On the Device Ports page, you can set up the numbering of Telnet, SSH, and TCP ports,  
view a summary of current port modes, establish the maximum number of direct  
connections for each device port, and select individual ports to configure.  
1. Click the Devices tab and select the Device Status option. The following page  
displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
8: Device Ports  
Current port numbering schemes for Telnet, SSH, and TCP ports display on the left.  
The list of ports 1-8 on the right includes the individual ports and their current mode.  
Note: For units with more ports, click the buttons above the table to view additional  
ports.  
Icons that represent some of the possible modes include:  
Idle  
The port is not in use.  
The port is in data/text mode.  
Note: You may set up ports to allow Telnet access using the IP  
Settings on the Device Ports – Settings page.  
An external modem is connected to the port. The user may dial into  
or out of the port.  
Telnet in or SSH in is enabled for the device port. The device port is  
either waiting for a Telnet or SSH login or has received a Telnet or  
SSH login (a user has logged in).  
To set up Telnet, SSH, and TCP port numbering:  
1. Enter the following:  
Telnet/SSH/TCP in Port Numbers  
Starting Telnet  
Port  
Each port is assigned a number for connecting via Telnet.  
Enter a number (1025-65535) that represents the first port.  
The default is 2000 plus the port number. For example, if  
you enter 2001, subsequent ports are automatically  
assigned numbers 2002, 2003, and so on.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Starting SSH Port  
Starting TCP Port  
Each port is assigned a number for connecting via SSH.  
Enter a number (1025-65535) that represents the first port.  
The default is 3000 plus the port number. For example, if  
you enter 3001, subsequent ports are automatically  
assigned numbers 3002, 3003, and so on.  
Each port is assigned a number for connecting through a  
raw TCP connection. Enter a number (1025-65535) that  
represents the first port. The default is 4000 plus the port  
number. For example, if you enter 4001, subsequent ports  
are automatically numbered 4002, 4003, and so on.  
You can use a raw TCP connection in situations where a  
TCP/IP connection is to communicate with a serial device.  
For example, you can connect a serial printer to a device  
port and use a raw TCP connection to spool print jobs to  
the printer over the network.  
Note: When using raw TCP connections to transmit binary  
data, or where the break command (escape sequence) is  
not required, set the Break Sequence of the respective  
device port to null (clear it).  
Caution: Ports 1-1024 are RFC-assigned and may conflict with services  
running on the SLB branch office manager. Avoid this range.  
2. Click the Apply button to save the settings.  
To set limits on direct connections:  
1. Enter the maximum number (1-10) of simultaneous direct connections for each  
device port. The default is 1.  
2. Click the Apply button to save the settings.  
To configure a specific port:  
1. You have two options:  
Select the port from the ports list and click the Configure button. The Device  
Ports – Settings page for the port displays.  
Click the port number on the green bar at the top of each page.  
Global Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
To configure settings for all or a group of device ports:  
set deviceport global <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
maxdirect <1-10>  
Sets the maximum number of direct connections for each device port.  
sshport <TCP Port>  
tcpport <TCP Port>  
telnetport <TCP Port>  
Port is a port number between 1025 and 65535.  
To view global settings for device ports:  
show deviceport global  
Global Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure settings for all or a group of device ports:  
set deviceport global <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
maxdirect <1-10>  
Sets the maximum number of direct connections for each device port.  
sshport <TCP Port>  
tcpport <TCP Port>  
telnetport <TCP Port>  
Port is a port number between 1025 and 65535.  
To view global settings for device ports:  
show deviceport global  
Device Ports – Settings  
On the Device Ports - Settings page, configure IP and data (serial) settings for individual  
ports, and if the port connects to an external modem, modem settings as well.  
To open the Device Ports – Settings page:  
1. You have two options:  
In the Device Ports page (described in the previous section), select the port from  
the ports list and click the Configure button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
8: Device Ports  
Click the desired port number in the green bar (shown below) at the top of any  
page:  
The following page displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
To enter device port settings:  
1. Enter the following:  
Mode  
Name  
The status of the port; displays automatically.  
The name of the port. Valid characters are letters, numbers,  
dashes (-), periods, and underscores ( _ ).  
Banner  
Text to display when a user connects to a device port by  
means of Telnet, SSH, or TCP. If authentication is enabled  
for the device port, the banner displays once the user  
successfully logs in. Blank is the default.  
Break Sequence  
A series of one to ten characters users can enter on the  
command line interface to send a break signal to the external  
device. A suggested value is Esc+B (escape key, then  
uppercase “B” performed quickly but not simultaneously).  
You would specify this value as \x1bB, which is hexadecimal  
(\x) character 27 (1B) followed by a B.  
Logging  
Click the Settings link to configure file logging, email logging,  
local logging, and PC Card logging. (See Device Ports –  
Zero Port Counters  
Connected to  
Resets all of the numerical values in the Port Counters table  
at the bottom of the page to zero (0).  
The type of device connected to the device port. Presently,  
the SLB branch office manager supports SLP power  
manager (SLP8 and SLP16) and Sensorsoft devices. If the  
type of device is not listed, select undefined.  
If you select anything other than undefined, click Device  
Commands. The appropriate web page displays.  
IP Settings  
Enable Telnet In  
Enable SSH In  
Enable TCP in  
Enables access to this port through Telnet. Disabled by  
default.  
Enables access to this port through SSH. Disabled by  
default.  
Enables access to this port through a raw TCP connection.  
Disabled by default.  
Note: When using raw TCP connections to transmit binary  
data, or where the break command (escape sequence) is not  
required, set the Break Sequence of the respective device  
port to null (clear it).  
Port  
Automatically assigned Telnet, SSH, and TCP port numbers.  
(See 8: Device Ports for information on setting up the  
numbering scheme.) You may override this value, if desired.  
Authenticate  
If selected, the SLB branch office manager requires user  
authentication before granting access to the port.  
Authenticate is selected by default for Telnet in and SSH  
in, but not for TCP in.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
IP Address  
IP address used for this device port so a user can Telnet,  
SSH, or establish a raw TCP connection to this address and  
connect directly to the device port.  
For Telnet and SSH, the default TCP port numbers (22 and  
23, respectively) are used to connect to the device port. For  
raw TCP, the TCP port number defined for TCP In to the  
device port is used.  
Web SSH/Telnet  
Columns  
Number of columns in the Web SSH/Telnet applet when this  
device port is accessed via the applet.  
Web SSH/Telnet  
Rows  
Number of rows in the Web SSH/Telnet applet when this  
device port is accessed via the applet.  
Data Settings  
Note: Check the serial device’s equipment settings and documentation for the  
proper settings. The device port and the attached serial device must have the  
same settings.  
Baud  
The speed with which the device port exchanges data with  
the attached serial device.  
From the drop-down list, select the baud rate. Most devices  
use 9600 for the administration port, so the device port  
defaults to this value. Check the equipment settings and  
documentation for the proper baud rate.  
Data Bits  
Number of data bits used to transmit a character. From the  
drop-down list, select the number of data bits. The default  
is 8 data bits.  
Stop Bits  
The number of stop bit(s) used to indicate that a byte of  
data has been transmitted. From the drop-down list, select  
the number of stop bits. The default is 1.  
Parity  
Parity checking is a rudimentary method of detecting  
simple, single-bit errors. From the drop-down list, select the  
parity. The default is none.  
Flow Control  
Enable Logins  
A method of preventing buffer overflow and loss of data.  
The available methods include none, xon/xoff (software),  
and RTS/CTS (hardware). The default is none.  
For serial devices connected to the device port, displays a  
login prompt and authenticates users. Successfully  
authenticated users are logged into the command line  
interface.  
Disabled is the default and is the correct setting if the  
device port is the endpoint for a connection.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Show Lines on  
Connecting  
If enabled, when the user either does a connect direct  
from the CLI or connects directly to the port using Telnet or  
SSH, the SLB outputs up to 24 lines of buffered data as  
soon as the serial port is connected.  
For example, an SLB branch office manager issues a  
connect direct device 1 command to connect port  
1 to a Linux server.  
Then the SLB device user gets a directory with the ls  
command exits the connection. When the SLB user issues  
another direct connect device 1”, the output of the  
ls command (or some portion of it) is output again, so the  
user can know what state the server was left in.  
Hardware Signal Triggers  
Check DSR on  
Connect  
If this setting is enabled, the device port only establishes a  
connection if DSR (Data Set Ready) is in an asserted state.  
DSR should already be in an asserted state, not  
transitioning to, when a connection attempt is made.  
Disabled by default unless dial-in, dial-out, or dial-back is  
enabled for the device port.  
Disconnect on  
DSR  
If a connection to a device port is currently in session, and  
the DSR signal transitions to a de-asserted state, the  
connection disconnects immediately. Disabled is the  
default unless dial-in, dial-out, or dial-back is enabled for  
the device port.  
Modem Settings  
Note: Depending on the State and Mode you select, different fields are  
available.  
State  
Indicates whether an external modem is attached to the  
device port. If enabling, set the modem to dial-out, dial-in,  
dial-back, dial-on-demand, dial-in/host list, or dial in & dial-  
on-demand. Disabled by default.  
Mode  
The format in which the data flows back and forth:  
Text: In this mode, the SLB branch office manager  
assumes that the modem will be used for remotely logging  
into the command line. Text mode can only be used for  
dialing in or dialing back. Text is the default.  
PPP: This mode establishes an IP-based link over the  
modem. PPP connections can be used in dial-out mode  
(e.g., the SLB device connects to an external network),  
dial-in mode (e.g., the external computer connects to the  
network that the SLB branch office manager is part of), or  
dial-on-demand.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Initialization Script  
Commands sent to configure the modem may have up to  
100 characters. Consult your modem’s documentation for  
recommended initialization options. If you do not specify  
an initialization script, the SLB device uses a default  
initialization string of AT S7=45 SO=0 L1 V1 X4 &D2  
&c1 E1 Q0.  
Note: We recommend that the modem initialization script  
always be preceded with AT and include E1 V1 x4 Q0 so  
that the SLB branch office manager may properly control  
the modem.  
Modem Timeout  
Caller ID Logging  
Timeout for all modem connections. Select Yes (default)  
for the SLB device to terminate the connection if no traffic  
is received during the configured idle time. Enter a value of  
from 1 to 9999 seconds. The default is 30 seconds.  
Select to enable the SLB branch office manager to log  
caller IDs on incoming calls. Disabled by default.  
Note: For the Caller ID AT command, refer to the modem  
user guide.  
Modem Command  
Modem AT command used to initiate caller ID logging by  
the modem.  
Note: For the AT command, refer to the modem user  
guide.  
Modem Settings: Text Mode  
Timeout  
Logins  
If you selected Text mode, you can enable logins to time  
out after the connection is inactive for a specified number  
of minutes. The default is No. This setting is only  
applicable for text mode connections. PPP mode  
connections stay connected until either side drops the  
connection. Disabled by default.  
Dial Back  
Number  
Users with dial-back access can dial into the SLB branch  
office manager and enter their login and password. Once  
the SLB device authenticates them, the modem hangs up  
and dials them back.  
Select the phone number the modem dials back on a fixed  
number or a number associated with their login. If you  
select Fixed Number, enter the number (in the format  
2123456789).  
Dial-in Host List  
From the drop-down list, select the desired host list. The  
host list is a prioritized list of SSH, Telnet, and TCP hosts  
that are available for establishing outgoing modem  
connections or for connect direct at the CLI. The hosts in  
the list are cycled through until the SLB branch office  
manager successfully connects to one.  
To establish and configure host lists, click the Host Lists  
link.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Modem Settings: PPP Mode  
Negotiate IP  
Address  
If the SLB branch office manager and/or the serial device  
have dynamic IP addresses (e.g., IP addresses assigned  
by a DHCP server), select Yes. Yes is the default.  
If the SLB branch office manager or the modem have fixed  
IP addresses, select No, and enter the local IP (IP address  
of the port) and remote IP (IP address of the modem).  
Authentication  
Enables PAP or CHAP authentication for modem logins.  
PAP is the default. With PAP, users are authenticated by  
means of the Local Users and any of the remote  
authentication methods that are enabled. With CHAP, the  
CHAP Handshake fields authenticate the user.  
CHAP Handshake  
The host/username (for UNIX systems) or secret/user  
password (for Windows systems) used for CHAP  
authentication. May have up to 128 characters.  
Same  
Select this option to let incoming connections (dial-in) use  
the same authentication settings as outgoing connections  
(dial-on-demand). If this option is not selected, then the  
dial-on-demand connections take their authentication  
settings from the DOD parameter settings. If DOD  
Authentication is PAP, then the DOD CHAP Handshake  
field is not used.  
authentication for  
Dial-in & Dial-on-  
Demand (DOD)  
DOD  
Authentication  
Enables PAP or CHAP authentication for dial-in & dial-on-  
demand. PAP is the default. With PAP, users are  
authenticated by means of the Local Users and any of the  
remote authentication methods that are enabled. With  
CHAP, the DOD CHAP Handshake fields authenticate the  
user.  
DOD CHAP  
Handshake  
For DOD Authentication, enter the host/username for  
UNIX systems) or secret/user password (for Windows  
systems) used for CHAP authentication. May have up to  
128 characters.  
Enable NAT  
Select to enable Network Address Translation (NAT) for  
dial-in and dial-out PPP connections on a per modem  
(device port or PC Card) basis. Users dialing into the SLB  
branch office manager access the network connected to  
Eth1 and/or Eth2.  
Note: IP forwarding must be enabled on the  
Network - Settings page for NAT to work. See 6: Basic  
Dial-out  
Number  
Phone number for dialing out to a remote system or serial  
device. May have up to 20 characters. Any format is  
acceptable.  
Dial-out  
Login  
User ID for dialing out to a remote system. May have up to  
32 characters.  
Dial-out Password  
and Retype  
Password for dialing out to a remote system. May have up  
to 64 characters.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Restart Delay  
The number of seconds after the timeout and before the  
SLB branch office manager attempts another connection.  
The default is 30 seconds.  
2. To save settings for just this port, click the Apply button.  
3. To save selected settings to ports other than the one you are configuring:  
a) From the Apply Settings drop-down box, select none, a group of settings, or  
All.  
b) In to Device Ports, type the device port numbers, separated by commas;  
indicate a range of port numbers with a hyphen (e.g., 2, 5, 7-10).  
Note: It may take a few minutes for the system to apply the settings to multiple  
ports.  
Port Status and Counters  
Port Counters describe the status of signals and interfaces. SLB branch office manager  
updates and increments the port counters as signals change and data flows in and out of  
the system. These counters help troubleshoot connections or diagnose problems  
because they give the user an overview of the state of various parameters. By setting  
them to zero and then re-checking them later, the user can view changes in status.  
The chart in the middle of the page displays the flow control lines and port statistics for  
the device port. The system automatically updates these values. To reset them to zeros,  
select the Zero port counters checkbox in the IP Settings section of the page.  
Note: Status and statistics shown on the web interface represent a snapshot in time. To  
see the most recent data, you must reload the web page.  
Device Ports – SLP Power Manager  
On the Device Ports – SLP page, configure commands to send to an SLP power  
manager or SLP expansion chassis that expands the number of power ports.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
8: Device Ports  
To open the Device Ports – SLP page:  
1. In the Connected to field above the IP Settings section of the Device Ports –  
Settings page, select an SLP or SLPEXP.  
2. Click the Device Commands link. The following page displays:  
To enter SLP commands:  
1. Enter the following:  
SLP Login  
User ID for logging into the SLP power manager.  
Password for logging into the SLP power manager.  
SLP  
Password/Retype  
Password  
SLP Status/Info  
Outlet Status  
Note: If there is an SLP power manager and an SLP  
Expansion chassis, the SLP power manager is Tower A and  
the Expansion chassis is Tower B.  
For Tower A or Tower B, select All Outlets or Single Outlet  
to view the status of all outlets or a single outlet of the SLP  
power manager. If you select Single Outlet, enter a value of  
1-8 for the SLP8 power manager or 1-16 for the SLP16  
power manager.  
Click the Outlet Status link to see the status of the selected  
outlet(s).  
Environmental  
Status  
Click the link to view the environmental status (e.g.,  
temperature and humidity) of the SLP power manager.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Infeed Status  
System Info  
Click the link to view the status of the data the SLP power  
manager is receiving.  
Click the link to see system information pertaining to the SLP  
device.  
SLP Commands  
Restart SLP  
To restart the SLP power manager, select the checkbox.  
Control Outlet  
For Tower A or Tower B, select All Outlets or Single Outlet  
and the number of the outlet to be controlled (1-8 for the  
SLP8 power manager or 1-16 for the SLP16 power manager)  
and select the command for the outlet (No Action, Power On,  
Power Off, Cycle Power). No Action is the default.  
2. Click the Apply button.  
Device Port – Sensorsoft Device  
Devices made by Sensorsoft are used to monitor environmental conditions.  
1. In the Connected to field above the IP Settings section of the Device Ports –  
Settings page, select Sensorsoft.  
2. Click the Device Commands link. The following page displays:  
3. Select a port and enter or view the following information:  
Device Port (view  
Number of the SLB port.  
only)  
Device Name (view  
Name of the SLB port.  
only)  
Temp (°C)  
Low Temp  
Current temperature (degrees Celsius) on the device the  
sensor is monitoring.  
Enter the temperature (degrees Celsius) permitted on the  
monitored device below which the SLB branch office  
manager sends a trap.  
High Temp  
Enter the temperature (degrees Celsius) permitted on the  
monitored device above which the SLB device sends a trap.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
Humidity (%)  
Low Humidity  
Current relative humidity on the device the sensor is  
monitoring.  
Enter the relative humidity permitted on the device the  
sensor is monitoring below which the sensor sends a trap to  
the SLB branch office manager.  
High Humidity  
Traps  
Enter the highest relative acceptable humidity permitted on  
the device above which the sensor sends a trap to the SLB  
device.  
Select to indicate the SLB branch office manager should  
send a trap or configured Event Alert when the sensor  
detects an out-of-range configured threshold.  
4. Click the Apply button.  
5. To view the status detected by the Sensorsoft, click the Sensorsoft Status link to  
the right of the table.  
Device Port Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure a single port or a group of ports:  
Example: set deviceport port 2-5,6,12,15-16 baud 2400  
set deviceport port <Device Port List or Name> <one or more  
device port parameters>  
Parameters:  
auth <pap|chap>  
banner <Banner Text>  
baud <300-115200>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
calleridcmd <Modem Command String>  
calleridlogging <enable|disable>  
chaphost <CHAP Host or User Name>  
chapsecret <CHAP Secret or User Password>  
The user defines the secret.  
checkdsr <enable|disable>  
closedsr <enable|disable>  
databits <7|8>  
device <none|slp8|slp16>  
dialinlist <Host List for Dial-in>  
dialoutnumber <Phone Number>  
dialoutlogin <User Login>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
dialoutpassword <Password>  
dialbacknumber <usernumber|Phone Number>  
dodauth <pap|chap>  
dodchaphost <CHAP Host or User Name>  
dodchapsecret <CHAP Secret or User Password>  
flowcontrol <none|xon/xoff|rts/cts>  
idletimeout <disable|1-9999 seconds>  
ipaddr <IP Address>  
initscript <Initialization Script>  
A script that initializes a modem.  
localipaddr <negotiate|IP Address>  
logins <enable|disable>  
modemmode <text|ppp>  
modemstate  
<disable|dialout|dialin|dialback|dialondemand|  
dialin+dialondemand|dialinhostlist>  
modemtimeout <disable|1-9999 seconds>  
name <Device Port Name>  
nat <enable|disable>  
parity <none|odd|even>  
remoteipaddr <negotiate|IP Address>  
restartdelay <PPP Restart Delay>  
showlines <enable|disable>  
sshauth <enable|disable>  
sshin <enable|disable>  
sshport <TCP Port>  
stopbits <1|2>  
tcpauth <enable|disable>  
tcpin <enable|disable>  
tcpport <TCP Port>  
telnetauth <enable|disable>  
telnetin <enable|disable>  
telnetport <TCP Port>  
timeoutlogins <disable or 1-30>  
webcolumns <Web SSH/Telnet Cols>  
webrows <Web SSH/Telnet Rows>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
To view the settings for one or more device ports:  
show deviceport port <Device Port List or Name>  
To view a list of all device port names:  
show deviceport names  
To view the modesand states of one or more device port(s):  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show portstatus [deviceport <Device Port List or Name>] [email  
<Email Address>]  
To view device port statistics and errors for one or more ports:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show portcounters [deviceport <Device Port List or Name>]  
[email <Email Address>]  
To zero the port counters for one or more device ports:  
show portcounters zerocounters <Device Port List or Name>  
Device Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To send commands to (or control) a device connected to an SLB device port  
over the serial port:  
Note: Currently the only devices supported for this type of interaction are the SLP  
and Sensorsoft devices.  
set command <Device Port # or Name or List> <one or more  
parameters>  
Parameters:  
slp auth login <User Login>  
Establishes the authentication information to log into the SLP power  
manager attached to the device port.  
slp restart  
Issues the CLI command the SLP power manager uses to restart  
itself.  
slp outletcontrol state <on|off|cyclepower>  
[outlet <Outlet #>][tower <A|B>]  
Outlet # is 1-8 for SLP8 power manager and 1-16 for SLP16 power  
manager.  
The outletcontrolparameters control individual outlets.  
slp outletstate [outlet <Outlet #>]  
The outletstateparameter shows the state of all outlets or a  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
single outlet.  
slp envmon  
Displays the environmental status (e.g., temperature and humidity)  
of the SLP power manager.  
slp infeedstatus  
Displays the infeed status and load of the SLP power manager.  
slp system  
Provides system information for the SLP power manager.  
sensorsoft lowtemp <Low Temperature in C.>  
Sets the lowest temperature permitted for the port.  
sensorsoft hightemp <High Temperature in C.>  
Sets the hightest temperature permitted for the port.  
sensorsoft lowhumidity <Low Humidity %>  
Sets the lowest humidity pemitted for the port.  
sensorsoft highhumidity <High Humidity %>  
Sets the lowest humidity permitted for the port.  
sensorsoft traps <enable|disable>  
Enables or disables traps when specified conditions are met.  
sensorsoft status  
Displays the status of the port.  
Interacting with a Device Port  
Once a device port has been configured and connected to an external device such as the  
console port of an external server, the data received over the device port can be  
monitored at the command line interface with the connect listencommand, as  
follows:  
To connect to a device port to monitor it:  
connect listen deviceport <Port # or Name>  
In addition, you can send data out the device port (for example, commands issued to an  
external server) with the connect direct command, as follows:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
To connect to a device port to monitor and/or interact with it, or to establish an  
outbound network connection:  
connect direct <endpoint>  
endpoint is one of:  
deviceport <Port # or Name>  
ssh <IP Address> [port <TCP Port>][<SSH flags>]  
where:  
<SSH flags> is one or more of:  
user <Login Name>  
version <1|2>  
command <Command to Execute>  
tcp <IP Address> port <TCP Port>  
telnet <IP Address> [port <TCP Port>]  
udp <IP Address> port <UDP Port>  
hostlist <Host List>  
Notes:  
To escape from the connect directcommand when the endpoint of the  
command is deviceport, tcp, or udpand return to the command line  
interface, type the escape sequence assigned to the currently logged in user. If  
the endpoint is telnet or SSH, logging out returns the user to the command  
line prompt.  
To escape from the connect listencommand, press any key.  
Setting up a user with an escape sequence is optional. For any NIS, LDAP,  
RADIUS, Kerberos, or TACACS+ user, or any local user who does not have an  
escape sequence defined, the default escape sequence is Esc+A.  
Device Ports – Logging  
The SLB products support port buffering of the data on the system's device ports as well  
as notification of receiving data on a device port. Port logging is disabled by default. You  
can enable more than one type of logging (local, NFS file, email/SNMP, or PC Card) at a  
time. The buffer containing device port data is cleared when any type of logging is  
enabled.  
Local Logging  
If local logging is enabled, each device port stores 256 Kbytes (approximately 400  
screens) of I/O data in a true FIFO buffer. You may view this data (in ASCII format) at the  
CLI with the show locallogcommand or on the Device Ports – Logging web page.  
Buffered data is normally stored in RAM and is lost in the event of a power failure if it is  
not logged using an NFS mount solution. If the buffer data overflows the buffer capacity,  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
8: Device Ports  
only the oldest data is lost, and only in the amount of overrun (not in large blocks of  
memory).  
NFS File Logging  
Data can be logged to a file on a remote NFS server. Data logged locally to the SLB  
branch office manager is limited to 256 Kbytes and may be lost in the event of a power  
loss. Data logged to a file on an NFS server does not have these limitations. The system  
administrator can define the directory for saving logged data on a port-by-port basis and  
configure file size and number of files per port.  
The directory path must be the local directory for one of the NFS mounts. For each  
logging file, once the file size reaches the maximum, a new file opens for logging. Once  
the number of files reaches the maximum, the oldest file is overwritten. The file naming  
convention is: <Device Port Number>_<Device Port Name>_<File number>.log.  
Examples:  
02_Port-2_1.log  
02_Port-2_2.log  
02_Port-2_3.log  
02_Port-2_4.log  
02_Port-2_5.log  
PC Card Logging  
Data can be logged to a PC Card Compact Flash that is loaded into one of the PC Card  
slots on the front of the SLB branch office manager and properly mounted (see PC Card  
Logging on page 99). Data logged locally to the SLB device is limited to 256 Kbytes and  
may be lost in the event of a power loss. Data logged to a PC Card Compact Flash does  
not have these limitations. The system administrator can define the file size and number  
of files per port. For each logging file, once the file size reaches the maximum, a new file  
opens for logging. Once the number of files reaches the maximum, the oldest file is  
overwritten. The file naming convention is: <Device Port Number>_<Device Port  
Name>_<File number>.log.  
Examples:  
02_Port-2_1.log  
02_Port-2_2.log  
02_Port-2_3.log  
02_Port-2_4.log  
02_Port-2_5.log  
Email/SNMP Notification  
The system administrator can configure the SLB branch office manager to send an email  
alert message indicating a particular condition detected in the device port log to the  
appropriate parties or an SNMP trap to the designated NMS (see 7: Services). The email  
or trap is triggered when a user-defined number of characters in the log from your server  
or device is exceeded, or a specific sequence of characters is received.  
Use the Device Ports – Logging page to set logging parameters on individual ports.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
8: Device Ports  
Sylog Logging  
Data can be logged to the system log. If this feature is enabled, the data will appear in  
the Device Ports log, under the Info level. The log level for the Device Ports log must be  
set to Info for the data to be saved to the system log. (See 7: Services.)  
To set logging parameters:  
1. In the top section of the Device Ports – Settings page, click the Settings link in the  
Logging field. The following page displays:  
2. Enter the following:  
Local Logging  
Local Logging  
If you enable local logging, each device port stores 256  
Kbytes (approximately 400 screens) of I/O data in a true  
FIFO buffer. Disabled by default.  
Clear Local Log  
View Local Log  
Select the checkbox to clear the local log.  
Click this link to see the local log in text format.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
Email/SNMP Traps  
Email/Traps  
Select the checkbox to enable email and SNMP logging.  
Email logging sends an email message to pre-defined  
email addresses or an SNMP trap to the designated NMS  
(see 7: Services) when alert criteria are met. Disabled by  
default.  
Send  
If you enabled email and SNMP logging, select what type  
of notification log to send: Email, SNMP, or Both. Email is  
the default.  
Trigger on  
Select the method of triggering a notification:  
Byte Count: A specific number of bytes of data. This is the  
default.  
Text String Recognition: A specific pattern of characters,  
which you can define by a regular expression.  
Note: Text string recognition may negatively impact the  
SLB device’s performance, particularly when regular  
expressions are used.  
Byte Threshold  
The number of bytes of data the port receives before the  
SLB branch office manager captures log data and sends a  
notification regarding this port. The default is 100 bytes.  
In most cases, the console port of your device does not  
send any data unless there is an alarm condition. After the  
SLB device receives a small number of bytes, it perceives  
that your device needs some attention. The SLB branch  
office manager notifies your technician when that point has  
been passed, and the notification includes the logged data.  
For example, a threshold preset at 30 characters means  
that as soon as the SLB device receives 30 bytes of data,  
it captures log data and sends an email regarding this port.  
Email Delay  
A time limit of how long (in seconds), after the SLB branch  
office manager detects the trigger, that the device port  
captures data before closing the log file (with a fixed  
internal buffer maximum capacity of 1500 bytes) and  
sending a notification. The default is 60 seconds.  
Restart Delay  
The number of seconds for the period after the notification  
has been sent during which the device port ignores  
additional characters received. The data is simply ignored  
and does not trigger additional alarms until this time  
elapses. The default is 60 seconds.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Text String  
The specific pattern of characters the SLB branch  
office manager must recognize before sending a  
notification to the technician about this port. The  
maximum is 100 characters. You may use a regular  
expression to define the pattern. For example, the  
regular expression “abc[def]g” recognizes the strings  
abcdg, abceg, abcfg.  
The SLB device supports GNU regular expressions; for  
more information, see:  
Email to  
The complete email address of the message recipient(s)  
for each device port(s). Each device port has its own  
recipient list. To enter more than one email address,  
separate the addresses with a single space. You can  
enter up to 128 characters.  
Email Subject  
A subject text appropriate for your site. May have up  
to 128 characters.  
The email subject line is pre-defined for each port with its  
port number. You can use the email subject to inform the  
desired recipients of the problem on a certain server or  
location (e.g., server location or other classification of your  
equipment). This is helpful if the email message goes to  
the system administrator’s or service technician's mobile or  
wireless device (e.g., text messaging by means of email).  
Note: The character sequence %d anywhere in the email  
subject is replaced with the device port number  
automatically.  
NFS File Logging  
NFS File Logging  
Select the checkbox to log all data sent to the device port  
to one or more files on an external NFS server. Disabled  
by default.  
Directory to Log to  
The path of the directory where the log files will be stored.  
Note: This directory must be a directory exported from an  
NFS server mounted on the SLB branch office manager.  
Specify the local directory path for the NFS mount.  
Max Number of  
Files  
The maximum number of files to create to contain log data  
to the port. These files keep a history of the data received  
from the port. Once this limit is exceeded, the oldest file is  
overwritten. The default is 10.  
Max Size of Files  
The maximum allowable file size in bytes. The default is  
2048 bytes. Once the maximum size of a file is reached,  
the SLB device begins generating a new file.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
PC Card Logging  
PC Card Logging  
Select to enable PC Card logging. A PC Card Compact  
Flash must be loaded into one of the PC Card slots on the  
front of the SLB branch office manager and properly  
mounted ((see PC Card Logging on page 99). Disabled by  
default.  
Log To  
If port logging is to a PC Card, select the slot (Upper or  
Lower) in which the PC Card has been inserted. Upper is  
the default.  
Max Number of  
Files  
The maximum number of files to create to contain log data  
to the port. These files keep a history of the data received  
from the port. Once this limit is exceeded, the oldest file is  
overwritten. The default is 10.  
Max Size of Files  
The maximum allowable file size in bytes. The default is  
2048 bytes. Once the maximum size of a file is reached,  
the SLB device begins generating a new file. The default is  
2048 bytes.  
Syslog Logging  
Syslog Logging  
Select to enable system logging.  
Note: The logging level for the device ports log must be  
set to Info to view Syslog entries for Device Port logging on  
the Services page.  
Note: To apply the settings to additional device ports, in the Apply settings to Device  
Ports field, enter the additional ports, (e.g., 1-3, 5, 6)  
3. To apply settings to other device ports in addition to the currently selected port,  
select the Apply settings to Device Ports and enter port numbers separated by  
commas. Indicate a range of port numbers with a hyphen (e.g., 2, 5, 7-10), and  
separate ranges with commas.  
4. To save, click the Apply button.  
Logging Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure logging settings for one or more device ports:  
Example: set deviceport port 2-5,6,12,15-16 baud 2400 locallogging  
enable  
Note: Local logging must be enabled for a device port for the locallogcommands to be  
executed. To use the set locallog clearcommand, the user must have permission to clear  
set deviceport port <Device Port List or Name> <one or more  
deviceport parameters>  
Parameters:  
emaildelay <Email Delay>  
emaillogging <disable|bytecnt|charstr>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
emailrestart <Restart Delay>  
emailsend <email|trap|both>  
emailstring <Regex String>  
emailsubj <Email Subject>  
emailthreshold <Byte Threshold>  
emailto <Email Address>  
filedir <Logging Directory>  
filelogging <enable|disable>  
filemaxfiles <Max # of Files>  
filemaxsize <Max Size of Files>  
locallogging <enable|disable>  
name <Device Port Name>  
nfsdir <Logging Directory>  
nfslogging <enable|disable>  
nfsmaxfiles <Max # of Files>  
nfsmaxsize <Size in Bytes>  
pccardlogging <enable|disable>  
pccardmaxfiles <Max # of Files>  
pccardmaxsize <Size in Bytes>  
pccardslot <upper|lower>  
sysloglogging <enable|disable>  
To view a specific number of bytes of data for a device port:  
show locallog <Device Port # or Name> [bytes <Bytes To Display>]  
1 Kbyte is the default.  
To clear the local log for a device port:  
set locallog clear <Device Port # or Name>  
Note: The locallogcommands can only be executed for a device port if local logging is enabled  
for the port. The set locallog clearcommand can only be executed if the user has  
permission to clear port buffers (see 11: User Authentication).  
Console Port  
The console port initially has the same defaults as the device ports. Use the Console Port  
page to change the settings, if desired.  
To set console port parameters:  
1. Click the Devices tab and select Console Port. The following page displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
2. Change the following as desired:  
Baud  
The speed with which the device port exchanges data with the  
attached serial device.  
From the drop-down list, select the baud rate. Most devices use 9600  
for the administration port, so the console port defaults to this value.  
Data Bits  
Stop Bits  
Number of data bits used to transmit a character. From the drop-down  
list, select the number of data bits. The default is 8 data bits.  
The number of stop bits that indicate that a byte of data has been  
transmitted. From the drop-down list, select the number of stop bits.  
The default is 1.  
Parity  
Parity checking is a rudimentary method of detecting simple, single-bit  
errors. From the drop-down list, select the parity. The default is none.  
Flow Control  
A method of preventing buffer overflow and loss of data. The available  
methods include none, xon/xoff (software), and RTS/CTS (hardware).  
The default is none.  
Timeout  
The number of minutes (1-30) after which an idle session on the  
console is automatically logged out. Disabled by default.  
Show Lines on  
Connecting  
If selected, when you connect to the console port with a terminal  
emulator, you will see the last lines output to the console, for example,  
the SLB boot messages or the last lines output during a CLI session  
on the console.  
3. Click the Apply button to save the changes.  
Console Port Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
To configure console port settings:  
set consoleport <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
baud <300-115200>  
databits <7|8>  
stopbits <1|2>  
parity <none|odd|even>  
flowcontrol <none|xon/xoff|rts/cts>  
showlines <enable|disable>  
timeout <disable|1-30>  
To view console port settings:  
show consoleport  
Power Outlets  
The SLB branch office manager has four outlets that can provide power to other units in  
an IT environment. Each outlet can be configured and controlled through the SLB device.  
The SLB can issue an SNMP trap if the total current for all four outlets exceeds a  
specified threshold.  
To configure a power outlet:  
1. Click the Devices tab and select the Power Outlets option. The following page  
displays:  
Note: The four red buttons (P1-P4) at the top of any page display the Device Ports  
– Power Outlets page.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
2. Enter the following:  
Switching Delay  
Number of milliseconds the SLB branch office manager between  
subsequent switching. The range is 1000-2500 msec. The  
default is 2000 msec (2 sec).  
Over Current  
Alarm  
If SNMP traps are enabled (see 7:Services), a trap (alarm) is  
sent if the total current for all outlets exceeds a threshold. Enter  
the number of amps (measured in tenths of an amp) above  
which the SLB device sends a trap. The maximum is 180.  
Note: If the alarm goes off, a warning message displays on the  
CLI.  
Current Level for  
all Outlets  
Displays the total load carried by the outlets.  
3. View or enter the following information for each outlet:  
Outlet  
Status  
Name  
Displays the number of the outlet being configured.  
Displays the current state of the outlet.  
User-configurable name identifying the outlet.  
User-configurable text describing the outlet.  
Description  
(optional)  
Power State  
Select whether the power should be on or off. Default is Off.  
Select whether, after a reboot, the power state for the outlet  
Wakeup Mode  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
should be on, off, or returned to the state it was in before the  
reboot. Default is Off.  
Last State  
Reboot  
Select whether to return the outlet to the state it was in before  
the reboot.  
To power cycle the outlet, select the checkbox. Default is  
unchecked.  
Note: You can reboot the SLB branch office manager on the  
Maintenance page, but after the reboot, the power outlet has the  
same power state as it did before the reboot.  
4. To save, click Apply.  
Power Outlet Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure and control power outlets:  
set power switchingdelay <Delay in msec>  
set power alarmthreshold <disable|Tenths of Amps>  
set power outlet <Outlet # or List or Name> <one or more  
parameters>  
Parameters:  
name <Outlet Name>  
description <Outlet Description>  
state <on|off>  
wakeup <on|off|laststate>  
reboot  
Example: set power outlet 1-2,4 state on  
To view power outlet settings:  
show power [outlet <Outlet # or Name>]  
Note: The screen displays PND when the outlet is powering up and is waiting for the  
delay period to expire. It displays RBT when an outlet has been told to reboot and is  
waiting for the reboot interval to expire (default is 20 seconds). The switching delay and  
the reboot interval are completely independent of each other.  
Host Lists  
A host list is a prioritized list of SSH, Telnet, and TCP hosts available for establishing  
incoming modem connections or for the connect directcommand on the CLI. The  
SLB branch office manager cycles through the list until it successfully connects to one.  
To add a host list:  
1. Click the Devices tab and select the Host Lists option. The following page  
displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
8: Device Ports  
2. Enter the following:  
Note: To clear fields in the lower part of the page, click the Clear Host List button.  
Host List Id (view  
Displays after a host list is saved.  
only)  
Host List Name  
Retry Count  
Enter a name for the host list.  
Enter the number of times the SLB branch office manager  
should attempt to retry connecting to the host list.  
Authentication  
Select to require authentication when the SLB device  
connects to a host.  
3. You have the following options:  
To save the host list without adding hosts at this time, click the Add Host List  
button.  
To add hosts, enter the following:  
Host Parameters  
Host  
Name or IP address of the host.  
Protocol  
Port  
Protocol for connecting to the host (TCP, SSH, or Telnet).  
Port on the host to connect to.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Escape Sequence  
The escape character used to get the attention of the SSH  
or Telnet client. It is optional, and if not specified, Telnet  
and SSH use their default escape character.  
For Telnet, the escape character is either a single  
character or a two-character sequence consisting of '^'  
followed by one character. If the second character is '?', the  
DEL character is selected. Otherwise, the second character  
is converted to a control character and used as the escape  
character.  
For SSH, the escape character is a single character.  
4. Click the right arrow. The host displays in the Hosts box.  
5. Repeat steps 2-4 to add more hosts to the host list.  
Note: To clear fields before adding the next host, click the Clear Host Parameters  
button.  
6. You have the following options:  
To remove a host from the host list, select the host in the Hosts box and click the  
left arrow.  
To give the host a higher precedence, select the host in the Hosts box and click  
the up arrow.  
To give the host a lower precedence, select the host in the Hosts box and click  
the down arrow.  
7. Click the Add Host List button. After the process completes, a link back to the  
Device Ports – Settings page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
To view or update a host list:  
1. In the Host Lists table, select the host list and click the View Host List button. The  
list of hosts display in the Hosts box.  
2. View, add, or update the following:  
Host List Id (view  
Displays after a host list is saved.  
only)  
Host List Name  
Retry Count  
Enter a name for the host list.  
Enter the number of times the SLB branch office manager  
should attempt to retry connecting to the host list.  
Authentication  
Select to require authentication when the SLB device  
connects to a host.  
Host Parameters  
Host  
Name or IP address of the host.  
Protocol  
Port  
Protocol for connecting to the host (TCP, SSH, or Telnet).  
Port on the host to connect to SLB branch office manager.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8: Device Ports  
Escape Sequence  
The escape character used to get the attention of the SSH  
or Telnet client. It is optional, and if not specified, Telnet  
and SSH use their default escape character.  
For Telnet, the escape character is either a single  
character or a two-character sequence consisting of '^'  
followed by one character. If the second character is '?', the  
DEL character is selected. Otherwise, the second character  
is converted to a control character and used as the escape  
character.  
For SSH, the escape character is a single character.  
3. You have the following options:  
To add a host to the host list, click the right arrow. The host displays in the  
Hosts box.  
To remove a host from the host list, select the host in the Hosts box and click the  
left arrow.  
To give the host a higher precedence, select the host in the Hosts box and click  
the up arrow.  
To give the host a lower precedence, select the host in the Hosts box and click  
the down arrow.  
4. Click the Edit Host List button. After the process completes, a link back to the  
Device Ports – Settings page displays.  
To delete a host list:  
1. Select the host list in the Host Lists table.  
2. Click the Delete Host List button. After the process completes, a link back to the  
Device Ports – Settings page displays.  
Host List Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure a prioritized list of hosts to be used for modem dial-in connections:  
set hostlist add|edit <Host List Name> [<parameters>]  
Parameters:  
name <Host List Name> (edit only)  
retrycount <1-10>  
Default is 3.  
auth <enable|disable>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8: Device Ports  
To add a new host entry to a list or edit an existing entry:  
set hostlist add|edit <Host List Name> entry <Host Number>  
[<parameters>]  
Parameters:  
host <IP Address or Name>  
protocol <ssh|telnet|tcp>  
port <TCP Port>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
To move a host entry to a new position in the host list:  
set hostlist edit <Host List Name> move <Host Number>  
position <Host Number>  
To delete a host list, or a single host entry from a host list:  
set hostlist delete <Host List> [entry <Host Number>]  
To display the members of a host list:  
show hostlist <all|names|Host List Name>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9: PC Cards  
You can use the PC Card page to configure storage (Compact Flash) and modem/ISDN  
PC cards. A Compact Flash is useful for saving and restoring configurations (see  
Configuration Management on page 182) and for Device Port Logging (see PC Card  
Logging on page 99). The SLB branch office manager supports a variety of Compact  
Flash-to-PC Card adapters, as well as modem and Basic Rate Interface (BRI) ISDN  
cards. (See the Lantronix web site for a complete list.)  
To set up PC Card storage in the SLB device:  
1. Insert any of the supported PC Cards into either of the PC Card bays on the front  
of the SLB branch office manager. (You can do this before or after powering up the  
SLB device.)  
If the card is a compact Flash-to-PC Card adapter, and the first partition on the  
Compact Flash is formatted with a file system supported by the SLB branch office  
manager (ext2 and FAT), the card mounts automatically.  
2. If the card does not mount automatically, or if you want to update its settings, click  
the Devices tab and select the PC Card option. The following page displays.  
3. From the PC Card Slots table, select the button (on the right) for the PC Card you  
want to configure for storage and click the Configure button. The following page  
displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
9: PC Cards  
4. Enter the following settings for the selected PC Card:  
Storage Settings  
Mount  
Select the checkbox to mount the first partition of the  
Compact Flash on the SLB device (if not currently  
mounted). Once mounted, a Compact Flash is used for  
device port logging and saving/restoring configurations.  
Unmount  
To eject the Compact Flash from the SLB branch office  
manager, first unmount the Compact Flash. Select the  
checkbox to unmount it.  
Warning: If you eject a Compact Flash from the SLB  
device without unmounting it, subsequent mounts of a  
PC Card Compact Flash in either slot may fail, and you  
will need to reboot the SLB branch office manager to  
restore PC Card functionality.  
Format  
Select to unmount the Compact Flash (if it is mounted),  
remove all existing partitions, create one partition on the  
Compact Flash, format it with the selected file system (ext2  
or FAT), and mount it.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
9: PC Cards  
Filesystem  
Select ext2 or FAT, the file systems the SLB device  
supports.  
5. Click the Apply button.  
To enter modem settings for a PC Card:  
1. Insert any of the supported modem or ISDN cards (see www.lantronix.com/slb) into  
either of the PC Card bays on the front of the SLB branch office manager. (You can  
do this before or after powering up the SLB device.)  
2. Click the Devices tab and select the PC Card option. The PC Card page displays.  
3. Select the PC Card you want to configure from the PC Card Slots table and click  
the Configure button. The PC Card – Modem/ISDN page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9: PC Cards  
4. Enter or view the following:  
State  
Select to indicate whether to disable the PC Card or set it  
for dial-in, dial-out, dial-back, dial-on-demand, or dial-in &  
dial-on-demand. Disabled by default.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9: PC Cards  
Mode  
The format in which the data flows back and forth.  
With Text selected, the SLB branch office manager  
assumes that the modem will be used for remotely logging  
into the command line. Text mode is only for dialing in.  
This is the default.  
PPP establishes an IP-based link over the modem. PPP  
connections can be used in dial-out mode (e.g., the SLB  
device connects to an external network) or dial-in mode  
(e.g., the external computer connects to the network that  
the SLB branch office manager is part of) or dial-on-  
demand. For ISDN cards, only PPP connections are  
allowed.  
Initialization Script  
Commands sent to configure the modem may have up to  
100 characters. Consult your modem’s documentation for  
recommended initialization options. If you do not specify  
an initialization script, the SLB device uses a uses a  
default initialization string of AT S7=45 SO=0 L1 V1 X4  
&D2 &c1 E1 Q0.  
Note: We recommend that the modem initialization script  
always be preceded with AT and include E1 V1 x4 Q0 so  
that the SLB branch office manager may properly control  
the modem.  
Modem Timeout  
Caller ID Logging  
Timeout for modem connections. Select Yes for the SLB  
branch office manager to terminate the connection if no  
traffic is received during the configured idle time. Enter a  
value of from 1 to 9999 seconds.  
Select to enable the SLB device to log caller IDs on  
incoming calls.  
Note: For the Caller ID AT command, refer to the modem  
user guide.  
Modem Command  
Modem AT command used to initiate caller ID logging by  
the modem.  
Note: For the AT command, refer to the modem user  
guide.  
Data Settings  
Baud  
The speed with which the device port exchanges data with  
the attached serial device.  
From the drop-down list, select the baud rate. Most devices  
use 9600 for the administration port, so this is the default.  
Check the equipment settings and documentation for the  
proper baud rate.  
Data Bits  
Number of data bits used to transmit a character. From the  
drop-down list, select the number of data bits. The default  
is 8 data bits.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
9: PC Cards  
Parity  
Parity checking is a rudimentary method of detecting  
simple, single-bit errors. From the drop-down list, select the  
parity. The default is none.  
Stop Bits  
Flow Control  
The number of stop bit(s) used to indicate that a byte of  
data has been transmitted. From the drop-down list, select  
the number of stop bits. The default is 1.  
A method of preventing buffer overflow and loss of data.  
The available methods include none, xon/xoff (software),  
and RTS/CTS (hardware). The default is none.  
ISDN Settings  
Note: These fields are disabled if the PC Card inserted is not an ISDN card.  
Channel  
Select to indicate which B channel on the ISDN card to  
use. Valid values are 1 and 2. (The B-channel is the  
channel that carries the main data.) Only one 64K channel  
can be used at a time.  
Phone Number  
Phone number associated with the B channel. May have  
up to 20 characters. Any format is acceptable.  
GSM/GPRS Settings  
These settings are only active when a GSM/GPRS PC card modem is in the appropriate  
slot.  
Notes:  
Please consult your wireless carrier's configuration requirements for more  
detailed information.  
Dial-out GPRS connections may replace the default route and DNS entries.  
Static routes may be required to maintain access to subnets that are not directly  
attached to the SLB branch office manager. Click the Static Routes link (above  
Data Settings) to configure a static route. (See Routing on page 58.)  
Dial-out Mode  
Select the type of dial-out connection:  
GPRS: (General Packet Radio Service)  
GSM: (Global System for Mobile communication)  
PIN and Retype  
PIN  
PIN (personal identification number) for accessing the  
GSM/GPRS card.  
GPRS Context  
Command to specify the protocol data packet (PDP)  
context parameter values.  
PPP Compression  
GSM Bearer Svc.  
Auto-acquire DNS  
Select to enable negotiation of data compression over PPP  
links. Disabled by default.  
Command to select the bearer service, data rate, and  
connection element to use when data call originate.  
Select to enable the SLB device to acquire up to three  
DNS servers by means of GPRS. Enabled by default.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
9: PC Cards  
Negotiated IP  
IP address associated with the GPRS connection.  
Text Mode  
Timeout  
Logins  
If you selected Text mode, you can enable logins to time  
out after the connection is inactive for a specified number  
of minutes. The default is No. This setting only applies to  
text mode connections. PPP mode connections stay  
connected until either side drops the connection. Disabled  
by default.  
Dial-back Number  
Users with dial-back access can dial into the SLB branch  
office manager and enter their login and password. Once  
the SLB device authenticates them, the modem hangs up  
and dials them back.  
Select the phone number the modem dials back on--a  
fixed number or a number associated with their login. If  
you select Fixed Number, enter the number (in the format  
2123456789).  
Dial-in Host List  
From the drop-down list, select the desired host list. The  
host list is a prioritized list of SSH, Telnet and TCP  
hosts that are available for establishing outgoing  
modem connections. The hosts in the list are cycled  
through until the modem successfully connects to  
one.  
To establish and configure host lists, click the Host Lists  
PPP Mode  
Negotiate IP  
Address  
If the SLB branch office manager and/or the serial device  
have dynamic IP addresses (e.g., IP addresses assigned  
by a DHCP server), select Yes. This is the default.  
If the SLB device or the modem have fixed IP addresses,  
select No, and enter the Local IP (IP address of the port)  
and Remote IP (IP address of the modem).  
Authentication  
Enables PAP or CHAP authentication for modem logins.  
PAP is the default. With PAP, users are authenticated by  
means of the Local Users and any of the remote  
authentication methods that are enabled. With CHAP, the  
CHAP Handshake fields authenticate the user.  
CHAP Handshake  
The host/username (for UNIX systems) or secret/user  
password (for Windows systems) used for CHAP  
authentication. May have up to 128 characters.  
Same  
Select this option to let incoming connections (dial-in) use  
the same authentication settings as outgoing connections  
(dial-on-demand). If this option is not selected, then the  
dial-on-demand connections take their authentication  
settings from the DOD parameter settings. If DOD  
Authentication is PAP, then the DOD CHAP Handshake  
field is not used.  
authentication for  
Dial-in & Dial-on-  
Demand (DOD)  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
9: PC Cards  
DOD  
Enables PAP or CHAP authentication for dial-in & dial-on-  
Authentication  
demand. PAP is the default. With PAP, users are  
authenticated by means of the Local Users and any of the  
remote authentication methods that are enabled. With  
CHAP, the DOD CHAP Handshake fields authenticate the  
user.  
DOD CHAP  
Handshake  
For DOD Authentication, enter the host/username for  
UNIX systems) or secret/user password (for Windows  
systems) used for CHAP authentication. May have up to  
128 characters.  
Enable NAT  
Select to enable Network Address Translation (NAT) for  
dial-in and dial-out PPP connections on a per modem  
(Device Port or PC Card) basis. Users dialing into the SLB  
branch office manager access the network connected to  
Eth1 and/or Eth2.  
Note: IP forwarding must be enabled on the Network -  
Settings page for NAT to work. To enable, click the IP  
Forwarding link to display the Network Settings page. See  
Dial-out  
Number  
Phone number for dialing out to a remote system or serial  
device. May have up to 20 characters. Any format is  
acceptable.  
Dial-out  
Login  
User ID for dialing out to a remote system. May have up to  
32 characters.  
Dial-out Password  
and Retype  
Password for dialing out to a remote system. May have up  
to 64 characters.  
Restart Delay  
The number of seconds after the timeout and before the  
SLB branch office manager attempts another connection.  
The default is 30 seconds.  
IP Settings  
Service  
The available connection services for this modem port  
(Telnet, SSH, or TCP). Only one can be active at a time.  
The default is None.  
Telnet Port  
Telnet session port number to use if you selected Telnet.  
Defaults:  
Upper PC Card Slot: 2049  
Lower PC Card Slot: 2050  
Range: 1025-65535  
SSH Port  
The SSH session port number to use if you selected SSH.  
Defaults:  
Upper PC Card Slot: 3049  
Lower PC Card Slot: 3050  
Range: 1025-65535  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
9: PC Cards  
TCP Port  
The TCP (raw) session port number to use if you selected  
TCP.  
Defaults:  
Upper PC Card Slot: 4049  
Lower PC Card Slot: 4050  
Range: 1025-65535  
Authenticate  
If selected, the SLB branch office manager requires user  
authentication before granting access to the port.  
Authenticate is selected by default for Telnet Port and  
SSH Port, but not for  
TCP Port.  
5. Click the Apply button.  
PC Card Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
PC Card Storage Commands  
To mount a Compact Flash card in the SLB branch office manager for use as a  
storage device:  
Note: The Compact Flash card must be formatted with an ext2 or FAT file system before you  
mount it.  
pccard storage mount <upper|lower>  
To view a directory listing of a Compact Flash card:  
pccard storage dir <upper|lower>  
To unmount a Compact Flash card:  
Note: Enter this command before ejecting the card.  
pccard storage unmount <upper|lower>  
To format a Compact Flash card:  
pccard storage format <upper|lower> [filesystem <ext2|fat>]  
To rename a file on a Compact Flash card:  
pccard storage rename <upper|lower> file <Filename> newfile <New  
Filename>  
To copy a file on a Compact Flash card:  
pccard storage copy <upper|lower> file <Filename> newfile <New  
Filename>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
9: PC Cards  
Removes a file on a Compact Flash card:  
pccard storage delete <upper|lower> file <Current Filename>  
PC Card Modem Commands  
To configure a currently loaded PC Card modem:  
pccard modem <upper|lower> <parameters>  
Parameters:  
auth <pap|chap>  
baud <300-115200> 9600 is the default.  
calleridcmd <Modem Command String>  
calleridlogging <enable| disable>  
chaphost <CHAP Host or User Password>  
chapsecret <CHAP Secret or User Password>  
databits <7|8>  
dialbacknumber <usernumber|Phone Number>  
dialinlist <Host List for Dial-in>  
dodauth <pap|chap>  
dodchaphost <CHAP Host or User Name>  
dodchapsecret <CHAP Secret or User Password>  
dialoutlogin <User Login>  
dialoutnumber <Phone Number>  
dialoutpassword <Password>  
flowcontrol <none|xon/xoff|rts|cts>  
gsmautodns <enable|disable>  
gsmbearerservice <GSM Bearer Service>  
gsmcompression <enable|disable>  
gsmcontext <GPRS Context Id>  
gsmdialoutmode <gprs|gsm>  
gsmpin <GSM/GPRS PIN Number>  
idletimeout <disable|1-9999 seconds>  
initscript <Initialization Script>  
isdnchannel <1|2>  
isdnnumber <Phone Number>  
localipaddr <negotiate|IP Address>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
9: PC Cards  
modemmode <text|ppp>  
modemstate  
<disable|dialout|dialin|dialback|dialondemand|  
dialin+dialondemand|dialinhostlist>  
modemtimeout <disable|1-9999 sec>  
nat <enable|disable>  
parity <none|odd|even>  
remoteipaddr <negotiate|IP Address>  
restartdelay <PPP Restart Delay>  
service <none|telnet|ssh|tcp>  
sshauth <enable|disable>  
sshport <TCP Port>  
stopbits <1|2>  
tcpauth <enable|disable>  
tcpport <TCP Port>  
telnetauth <enable|disable>  
telnetport <TCP Port>  
timeoutlogins <disable|1-30>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10: Connections  
Chapter 8: Device Ports described how to configure and interact with an SLB branch  
office manager device port connected to an external device. This chapter describes how  
to use the Connections web page to connect external devices and outbound network  
connections (such as Telnet or SSH) in various configurations.  
An SLB device port attached to an external device can be connected to one of the  
following endpoints:  
Another device port attached to an external device  
Another device port with a modem attached  
An outgoing Telnet or SSH session  
An outgoing TCP or UDP network connection  
This enables the user to set up connections such as those described in the next section.  
You can establish a connection at various times:  
Immediately. These connections are always re-established after reboot.  
At a specified date and time. These connections connect if the date and time  
have already passed.  
After a specified amount of data or a specified sequence of data passes through  
the connection. Following reboot, the connection is not reestablished until the  
specified data passes through the connection.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10: Connections  
Typical Setup Scenarios for the SLB Device  
Following are typical configurations in which SLB connections can be used, with  
references to settings on the Connections and Device Ports web pages.  
Terminal Server  
In this setup, the SLB branch office manager acts as a multiplexer of serial data to a  
single server computer. Terminal devices are connected to the serial ports of the SLB  
device and configured as a Device Port to Telnet out type connection on the  
Connections page. The users of the terminals can access the server as if they were  
connected directly to it by local serial ports or a console.  
VT100 Terminals  
Server  
SLB Branch Office Manager  
Telnet  
Sessions  
(via Network  
connection)  
Serial  
Connections  
Remote Access Server  
In this setup, the SLB branch office manager is connected to one or more modems by its  
device ports. Configure the device ports on the Device Ports - Settings web page by  
selecting the Dial-in option in the Modem Settings section. Most customers use the  
modems in PPP mode to establish an IP connection to the SLB device and either Telnet  
or SSH into the SLB branch office manager. They could also select text mode where,  
using a terminal emulation program, a user could dial into the SLB device and connect to  
the command line interface.  
Modems  
SLB Branch Office Manager  
Internal  
Phone  
Network  
System  
Serial  
Network  
Connections  
Connections  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
10: Connections  
Reverse Terminal Server  
In this scenario, the SLB branch office manager has one or more device ports connected  
to one or more serial ports of a mainframe server. Users can access a terminal session  
by establishing a Telnet or SSH session to the SLB device. To configure the SLB branch  
office manager, select the Enable Telnet In or Enable SSH In option on the Device  
Ports – Settings web page.  
PC  
UNIX Server  
SLB Branch Office Manager  
PC  
Telnet/SSH  
Sessions  
Serial  
Sessions  
PC  
Multiport Device Server  
A PC can use the device ports on the SLB device as virtual serial ports, enabling the  
ports to act as if they are local ports to the PC. To use the SLB branch office manager in  
this setup, the PC requires special software, for example, Com Port Redirector (available  
on www.lantronix.com) or similar software).  
Serial  
Printer  
Windows/Linux PC  
SLB Branch Office Manager  
Modem  
Raw TCP  
Serial Connections  
Sessions  
Serial  
Device  
Console Server  
For this situation, the SLB branch office manager is configured so that the user can  
manage a number of servers or pieces of network equipment using their console ports.  
The device ports on the SLB are connected to the console ports of the equipment that the  
user would like to manage. To manage a specific piece of equipment, the user can Telnet  
or SSH to a specific port or IP address on the SLB device and be connected directly to  
the console port of the end server or device. To configure this setup, set the Enable  
Telnet In or Enable SSH In option on the Device Ports – Settings web page for the  
device port in question. The user can implement an extra remote management capability  
by adding a modem to one of the device ports and setting the Dial-in option in the  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
10: Connections  
Modem Settings section of the Device Ports – Settings web page. A user could then dial  
into the SLB branch office manager using another modem and terminal emulation  
program at a remote location.  
Serial Terminal  
Sessions  
Web Server  
Telnet/SSH  
Sessions  
SLB Branch Office Manager  
Switch  
Router  
Modem  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10: Connections  
Connection Configuration  
To create a connection:  
1. Click the Devices tab and select the Connections opton. The following page  
displays:  
2. For a device port, enter the following:  
Port  
The number of the device port you are connecting.  
This device port must be connected to an external serial device and must  
not have command line interface logins enabled, be connected to a  
modem, or be running a loopback test.  
Note: To see the current settings for this device port, click the Settings  
link.  
Data Flow  
Select the arrow showing the direction (bidirectional or unidirectional) the  
data will flow in relationship to the device port you are connecting.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10: Connections  
to  
From the drop-down list, select a destination for the connection: a device  
port connected to a serial device, a device port connected to a modem,  
or an outbound network connection (Telnet, SSH, TCP Port, or UDP  
Port).  
Note: To see the current settings for a selected device port, click the  
Settings link.  
Hostname  
Port  
The host name or IP Address of the destination. This entry is required if  
the to field is set to Telnet out, SSH out, TCP port, or UDP port.  
If the to field is set to Device Port or Modem on Device Port, enter the  
number of the device port. For all other options, this is the TCP/UDP port  
number, which is optional for Telnet out and SSH out, but required for  
TCP Port and UDP Port.  
Notes:  
If you select Device Port, it must not have command line interface logins  
enabled or be running a loopback test.  
To view the device port's settings, click the Settings link to the right of  
the port number.  
SSH Out Options  
Select one of the following optional flags to use for the SSH connection.  
User: Login ID to use for authenticating on the remote host.  
Version: Version of SSH. Select 1 or 2.  
Command: Enter a specific command on the remote host (for example,  
reboot).  
Trigger  
Select the condition that will trigger a connection. Options include:  
Connect now: Connects immediately, or if you reboot the SLB branch  
office manager, immediately on reboot.  
Connect at date/time: Connects at a specified date and time. Use the  
drop-down lists to complete the date and time. Upon rebooting, the SLB  
device reestablishes the connection if the date/time has passed.  
Auto-connect on characters transferring: Select the arrow indicating  
the direction of the data transfer and either the minimum number of  
characters or a specific character sequence that will trigger the  
connection.  
You can select the direction of the data transfer only if Data Flow is  
bidirectional. Upon rebooting, the SLB branch office manager does not  
reestablish the connection until the specified data has passed through  
one of the endpoints of the connection.  
3. To save, click the Apply button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10: Connections  
To view, update, or disconnect a current connection:  
The bottom of the Connections web page displays current connections.  
4. To view details about a connection, hold the mouse over the arrow in the Flow  
column.  
5. To disconnect (delete) a connection, select the connection in the Select column  
and click the Terminate button.  
6. To reestablish the connection, create the connection again in the top part of the  
page.  
7. To view information about Web connections, click the here link in the text above  
the table. The Firmware & Configurations - Web Sessions page displays.  
Connection Commands  
These commands for configuring connections correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
To connect to a device port to monitor and/or interact with it, or to establish an  
outbound network connection:  
connect direct <endpoint>  
Endpoint is one of:  
deviceport <Port # or Name>  
ssh <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port>] [<SSH  
flags>]  
where <SSH flags>is one or more of:  
user <Login Name>  
version <1|2>  
command <Command to Execute>  
tcp <IP Address> [port <TCP Port>]  
telnet <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port>]  
udp <IP Address> [port <UDP Port>]  
hostlist <Host List>  
To configure initial timeout for outgoing connections:  
Note: This is not a TCP timeout.  
connect global outgoingtimeout <disable|1-9999 seconds>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10: Connections  
To monitor a device port:  
connect listen deviceport <Device Port # or Name>  
To connect a device port to another device port or an outbound network  
connection (data flows in both directions):  
connect bidirection <Port # or Name> <endpoint>  
Endpoint is one of:  
charcount <# of Chars>  
charseq <Char Sequence>  
charxfer <toendpoint|fromendpoint>  
deviceport <Device Port # or Name>  
date <MMDDYYhhmm[ss]>  
exclusive <enable|disable>  
ssh <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port] [<SSH  
flags>]  
where <SSH flags> is one or more of:  
user <Login Name>  
version <1|2>  
command <Command to Execute>  
tcp <IP Address> [port <TCP Port>]  
telnet <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port>]  
trigger <now|datetime|chars>  
udp <IP Address> [port <UDP Port>]  
Note: If the trigger is datetime(establish connection at a specified date/time), enter the date  
parameter. If the trigger is chars(establish connection on receipt of a specified number or  
characters or a character sequence), enter the charxferparameter and either the charcountor  
the charseq parameter.  
To connect a device port to another device port or an outbound network  
connection (data flows in one direction):  
connect unidirection <Device Port # or Name> dataflow  
<toendpointfromendpoint> <endpoint>  
Endpoint is one of:  
charcount <# of Chars>  
charseq <Char Sequence>  
datetime <MMDDYYhhmm[ss]>  
deviceport <Port # or Name>  
exclusive <enable|disable>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10: Connections  
ssh <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port] >]  
<SSH flags>]  
where <SSH flags> is one or more of:  
user <Login Name>  
version <1|2>  
command <Command to Execute>  
tcp <IP Address> [port <TCP Port>]  
telnet <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port]  
trigger <now|datetime|chars>  
udp <IP Address> [port <UDP Port>]  
Note: If the trigger is datetime(establish connection at a specified date/time), enter the date  
parameter. If the trigger is chars(establish connection on receipt of a specified number or  
characters or a character sequence), enter either the charcountor the charseq parameter.  
To terminate a bidirectional or unidirectional connection:  
connect terminate <Connection ID>  
To view connections and their IDs:  
Note: The connection IDs are in the left column of the resulting table. The connection ID associated  
with a particular connection may change if the connection times out and is restarted.  
show connections [email <Email Address>].  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
To display details for a single connection:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show connections connid <Connection ID> [email <Email Address>  
To display global connections:  
connect global show  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Users who attempt to log in to the SLB branch office manager by means of Telnet, SSH,  
the console port, or one of the device ports are granted access by one or more  
authentication methods.  
The User Authentication page provides a submenu of methods (Local Users, NIS, LDAP,  
RADIUS, Kerberos, and TACACS+) for authenticating users attempting to log in. Use this  
page to assign the order in which the SLB device will use the methods. By default, local  
user authentication is enabled and is the first method the SLB branch office manager  
uses to authenticate users. If desired, you can disable local user authentication or assign  
it a lower precedence.  
Note: Regardless of whether local user authentication is enabled, the local user  
sysadmin account is always available for login.  
Authentication can occur using all methods, in the order of precedence, until a successful  
authentication is obtained, or using only the first authentication method that responds (in  
the event that a server is down).  
If you have the same user name defined in multiple authentication methods, the result is  
unknown.  
Example:  
There is an LDAP user "joe" and an NIS user "joe" and the order of  
authentication methods is:  
1 - Local Users  
2 - LDAP  
3 - NIS  
User "joe" tries to log in. Because there is an LDAP user "joe," the SLB branch  
office manager tries to authenticate him against his LDAP password first. If he  
fails to log in, then the SLB device may (or may not) try to authenticate him  
against his NIS "joe" user password.  
To enable, disable, and set the precedence of authentication methods:  
1. From the main menu, select User Authentication. The following page displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
2. To enable a method currently in the Disabled methods list, select the method and  
press the left arrow to the left of the list. The methods include:  
NIS (Network  
Information  
System)  
A network naming and administration system developed by Sun  
Microsystems for smaller networks. Each host client or server  
computer in the system has knowledge about the entire system. A user  
at any host can access files or applications on any host in the network  
with a single user identification and password.  
NIS uses the client/server model and the Remote Procedure Call  
(RPC) interface for communication between hosts. NIS consists of a  
server, a library of client programs, and some administrative tools. NIS  
is often used with the Network File System (NFS).  
LDAP (Lightweight  
Directory Access  
Protocol)  
A set of protocols for accessing information directories, specifically  
X.500-based directory services. LDAP runs over TCP/IP or other  
connection-oriented transfer services.  
RADIUS (Remote  
Authentication  
Dial-In User  
An authentication and accounting system used by many Internet  
Service Providers (ISPs). A client/server protocol, it enables remote  
access servers to authenticate dial-in users and authorize their access  
to the requested system or service.  
Service)  
RADIUS allows a company to maintain user profiles in a central  
database that all remote servers can share. It increases security,  
allowing a company to set up a policy that can be applied at a single  
administered network point.  
Kerberos  
Kerberos is a network authentication protocol that enables two parties  
to exchange private information across an unprotected network.  
It works by assigning a unique electronic credential, called a ticket, to  
each user who logs on to the network. The ticket is embedded in  
messages to identify the sender.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
TACACS+  
TACACS+ allows a remote access server to communicate with an  
authentication server to determine whether the user has access to the  
network. TACACS+ is a completely new protocol and is not compatible  
with TACACS or XTACACS. The SLB branch office manager supports  
TACACS+ only.  
(Terminal Access  
Controller Access  
Control System)  
Local Users  
Local accounts authenticate users who attempt to log in via SSH,  
Telnet, the Web, or the console port.  
3. To disable a method currently in the Enabled methods list, select the method and  
click the right arrow between the lists.  
4. To set the order in which the SLB branch office manager will authenticate users,  
use the up and down arrows to the left of the Enabled methods list.  
5. For Attempt next method on authentication rejection, you have the following  
options:  
To enable the SLB device to use all methods, in order of precedence, until it  
obtains a successful authentication, select the check box. This is the default.  
To enable the SLB branch office manager to use only the first authentication  
method that responds (in case a server is down or unavailable), clear the  
check box.  
6. Click Apply.  
Now that you have enabled one or more authentication methods, you must configure  
them.  
Authentication Commands  
The following command for the command line interface corresponds to the web page  
entries described above.  
To set ordering of authentication methods:  
Note: Local Users authentication is always the first method used. Any methods omitted from the  
command will be disabled.  
set auth <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
authusenextmethod <enable|disable>  
kerberos <1-6>  
ldap <1-6>  
localusers <1-6>  
nis <1-6>  
radius <1-6>  
tacacs+ <1-6>  
To view authentication methods and their order of precedence:  
show auth  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
Local and Remote Users  
The system administrator can configure the SLB device to use local accounts and remote  
accounts to authenticate users.  
1. Click the User Authentication tab and select the Local/Remote Users option.  
The following page displays.  
The top of the page has entry fields for enabling local and remote users and for setting  
password requirements. The bottom of the page displays a table listing and describing all  
local and remote users.  
To enable local and/or remote users:  
1. Enter the following:  
Enable Local  
Users  
Select to enable all local users except sysadmin. The  
sysadmin is always available regardless of how you set the  
check box. Enabled by default.  
Authenticate only  
users who are in  
the remote users  
list  
Select the check box to authenticate users listed in the  
Remote Users list in the lower part of the page. Disabled by  
default.  
2. Click the Apply button.  
To set password requirements for local users:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
Local User Passwords  
Complex  
Select to enable the SLB branch office manager to enforce  
Passwords  
rules concerning the password structure (e.g., alphanumeric  
requirements, number of characters, punctuation marks).  
Disabled by default.  
Complexity rules:  
Passwords must be at least eight characters long.  
They must contain one upper case letter (A-Z), one lower case  
letter (a-z), one digit ( 0-9), and one punctuation character  
(()`~!@#$%%^&*-+=\{}[]:;"'<>,.?/_).  
Allow Reuse  
Select to enable users to continue to reuse old passwords. If  
you disable the check box, they cannot use any of the Reuse  
History number of passwords. Enabled by default.  
Reuse History  
The number of passwords the user must use before reusing an  
old password. The default is 4.  
For example, if you set reuse history to 4, the user may reuse  
an old password after using 4 other passwords.  
Password  
The number of days until the password expires. The default  
Lifetime (days)  
setting is 90.  
Warning Period  
(days)  
The number of days ahead that the system warns that the  
user's password will expire. The default setting is 7.  
Max Login  
Attempts  
The number of times (up to 8) the user can attempt to log in  
unsuccessfully before the system locks the user out. The  
default setting is 0 (disabled).  
Lockout Period  
(minutes)  
The number of minutes (up to 90) the locked-out user must  
wait before trying to log in to the web interface again. The  
default setting is 0 (disabled).  
3. Click the Apply button.  
To add, edit, or delete a user:  
You can delete a user listed in the table on this page or open the page for adding or  
editing a user.  
You have the following options:  
To add a user, click the Add/Edit User button. The Local/Remote User Settings  
To edit a user, select the user in the table and click the Add/Edit User button.  
The Local/Remote User Settings page displays.  
To delete a user, select the user in the table, click the Delete button, and then  
click the Apply button.  
Local/Remote User Settings  
On this page, you can add, edit, or delete a local or remote user.  
To add a user:  
1. On the Local/Remote Users page (described above), click the Add/Edit User  
button. The Local/Remote User Settings page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
2. Enter the following information for the user:  
Login  
User ID of selected user.  
Authentication  
Select the type of authenticated user:  
Local: User listed in the SLB database.  
Remote: User not listed in the SLB database.  
UID  
A unique numeric identifier the system administrator assigns to  
each user. Valid UIDs are 101-4294967295.  
Note: The UID must be unique. If it is not, SLB branch office  
manager automatically increments it. Starting at 101, the SLB finds  
the next unused UID.  
Listen Ports  
Data Ports  
The device ports that the user may access to view data using the  
connect listencommand. Enter the port numbers or the range  
of port numbers (for example, 1, 5, 8, 10-15). U and L denote the  
PC Card upper and lower slots.  
The device ports with which the user may interact using the  
connect directcommand. Enter the port numbers or the range  
of port numbers.  
Clear Port  
Buffers  
The device port buffers the users may clear using the set  
locallog clearcommand. Enter the port numbers or the range  
of port numbers.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Access  
Outlets  
The outlets the user may monitor and configure.  
Enable for  
Dial-back  
Select to grant a local user dial-back access (see page 84). Users  
with dial-back access can dial into the SLB branch office manager  
and enter their login and password. Once the SLB device  
authenticates them, the modem hangs up and dials them back.  
Disabled by default.  
Dial-back  
Number  
The phone number the modem dials back on depends on this  
setting for the device port. The user is either dialed back on a fixed  
number (specified on the Device Port - Settings page), or on a  
number that is associated with the user’s login (specified here).  
Escape  
Sequence  
A single character or a two-character sequence that causes the  
SLB branch office manager to leave direct (interactive) mode. (To  
leave listen mode, press any key.)  
A suggested value is Esc+A (escape key, then uppercase "A"  
performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would specify this  
value as \x1bA, which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27 (1B)  
followed by an A.  
This setting allows the user to terminate the connect direct  
command on the command line interface when the endpoint of the  
command is deviceport, tcp, or udp.  
Break  
Sequence  
A series of 1-10 characters users can enter on the command line  
interface to send a break signal to the external device. A suggested  
value is Esc+B (escape key, then uppercase “B” performed quickly  
but not simultaneously). You would specify this value as \x1bB,  
which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27 (1B) followed by a B.  
Custom Menu  
If custom menus have been created, you can assign a default  
custom menu to the user. The custom menu will display at login.  
Note: In the Local Users table, if the menu assigned to a local user  
no longer exists, it is marked with an asterisk (*).  
Display Menu  
at Login  
If custom menus have been created, select to enable the menu to  
display when the user logs into the CLI.  
Password/  
When a user logs into the SLB branch office manager, the SLB  
device prompts for a password (up to 64 characters). The sysadmin  
establishes that password here.  
Retype  
Password  
Password  
Expires  
If not selected, allows the user to keep a password indefinitely. If  
selected the user keeps the password for a set period. (See Local  
and Remote Users on page 137 for information on specifying the  
length of time before the password expires.)  
Allow  
Select to allow the user to change password.  
Password  
Change  
Change  
Password on  
Next Login  
Indicate whether the user must change the password at the next  
login.  
Lock Account  
Select to lock the account indefinitely.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
3. Assign rights to users. Each user is a member of a group that has a predefined  
user rights associated with it. You can assign or remove additional rights to the  
individual user.  
Group  
Select the group to which the user will belong:  
Default Users: This group has only the most basic rights.  
You can specify additional rights for the individual user .  
Power Users: This group has the same rights as Default  
Users plus Networking, Date/Time, Reboot & Shutdown,  
and Diagnostics & Reports. You can specify additional  
rights for the individual user.  
Administrators: This group has all possible rights.  
Full Administrative  
Right to perform any function on the SLB branch office  
manager.  
Networking  
Services  
Right to enter network and routing settings.  
Right to enable and disable system and audit logging, SSH  
and Telnet logins, SNMP, and SMTP. Includes NFS and  
CIFS.  
Secure Lantronix  
Network  
Right to view and manage secure IT management units (e.g.,  
SLP power managers, Spiders, SLB branch office managers)  
on the local subnet.  
Date/Time  
Right to set the date and time.  
Local Users  
Right to add or delete local users on the system.  
Remote  
Authentication  
Right to assign a remote user to a user group and assign a  
set of rights to the user. Includes configuring remote  
authentication methods and ordering  
SSH Keys  
Right to set SSH keys for authenticating users.  
Right to create or edit a custom user menu for the CLI.  
Right to access Web Manager.  
User Menus  
Web Access  
Reboot &  
Shutdown  
Right to shutdown or reboot the SLB branch office manager.  
Firmware &  
Configuration  
Right to upgrade the firmware on the unit and save or restore  
a configuration (all settings).  
Diagnostics &  
Reports  
Right to obtain diagnostic information and reports about the  
unit.  
Device Ports  
PC Card  
Right to enter device port settings. Includes creating  
bidirectional and unidirection connections  
Right to enter modem settings for PC cards. Includes  
managing storage PC Cards.  
Power Outlets  
Right to view and enter settings for power outlets.  
4. Click the Apply button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
5. Click the Back to Local/Remote Users link to return to the Local/Remote User  
Settings page.  
6. Add another user or click the Back to Local/Remote Users link. The  
Local/Remote Users page displays with the new user(s) listed in the table.  
Note: The logged-in user's name displays at the top of the web page. Only the tabs and  
options for which the user has rights display.  
To add a user based on an existing user:  
Shortcut  
1. Display the existing user on the Local/Remote Users Settings page. The fields in  
the top part of the page display the current values for the user.  
2. Change the Login to that of the new user. It is best to change the Password too.  
3. Click the Apply button.  
To edit a local user:  
1. On the Local/Remote Users page, select the user and click the Add/Edit User  
button. The Local/Remote User Settings page displays.  
2. Update values as desired.  
3. Click the Apply button.  
To delete a local user:  
1. On the Local/Remote Users page, select the user and click the Add/Edit User  
button. The Local/Remote User Settings page displays.  
2. Click the Delete User button.  
3. Click the Apply button.  
To change the sysadmin password:  
1. On the Local/Remote Users page, select sysadmin and click the Add/Edit User  
button. The Local/Remote User Settings page displays.  
2. Enter the new password in the Password and Retype Password fields.  
Note: You can change Escape Sequence and Break Sequence, if desired. You  
cannot delete the UID or change the UID, port permissions, or custom menu.  
3. Click the Apply button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Local Users Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure local accounts (including sysadmin) who log in to the SLB branch  
office manager by means of SSH, Telnet, the Web, or the console port:  
set localusers add|edit <User Login> <parameters>  
Parameters:  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
allowdialback <enable|disable>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
changenextlogin <enable|disable>  
changepassword <enable|disable>  
clearports <Port List>  
custommenu <Menu Name>  
dataports <Port List>  
dialbacknumber <Phone Number>  
displaymenu <enable|disable>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
group <default|power|admin|>  
listenports <Port List>  
passwordexpires <enable|disable>  
permissions <Permission List>  
uid <User Identifier>  
To set whether a complex login password is required:  
set localusers complexpasswords <enable|disable>  
To enable or disable authentication of local users:  
set localusers state <enable|disable>  
To set a login password for the local user:  
set localusers password <User Login>  
To delete a local user:  
set localusers delete <User Login>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
To view settings for all users or a local user:  
show localusers [user <User Login>]  
To block (lock out) a user's ability to log in:  
set localusers lock <User Login>  
Note: This capability is not available on the web page.  
To allow (unlock) a user's ability to log in:  
set localusers unlock <User Login>  
Note: This capability is not available on the web page.  
Local User Rights Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To add a local user to a user group or to change the group the user belongs to:  
set localusers add|edit <user> group <default|power|admin>  
To set a local user's permissions (not defined by the user group):  
set localusers add|edit <user> permissions <Permission List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp,  
pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter abbreviation for a user  
right.  
To view the rights of the currently logged-in user:  
show user  
Remote User Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To configure whether remote users who are not part of the remote user list will be  
authenticated:  
set remoteusers listonlyauth <enable|disable>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
11: User Authentication  
To configure attributes for users who log in by a remote authentication method:  
set remoteusers add|edit <User Login> [<parameters>]  
Parameters  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
clearports <Port List>  
dataports <Port List>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
group <default|power|admin>  
listenports <Port List>  
permissions <Permissions List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra,  
sk, um, dp, pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter  
abbreviation for a user right.  
To remove a remote user:  
set remoteusers delete <User Login>  
To view settings for all remote users:  
show remoteusers  
To view the rights of the currently logged-in user:  
show user  
NIS  
The system administrator can configure the SLB branch office manager to use NIS to  
authenticate users attempting to log in to the SLB device through the Web, SSH, Telnet,  
or the Console port. If NIS does not provide port permissions, you can use this page to  
grant device port access to users who are authenticated through NIS.  
All NIS users are members of a group that has predefined user rights associated with it.  
You can assign additional user rights that are not defined by the group.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use NIS to authenticate users:  
1. Click the User Authentication tab and select the NIS option.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
2. Enter the following:  
Enable NIS  
Displays selected if you enabled this method on the  
Authentication Methods page. If you want to set up this  
authentication method but not enable it immediately, clear  
the checkbox.  
Note: You can enable NIS here or on the first User  
Authentication page. If you enable NIS here, it automatically  
displays at the end of the order of precedence on the User  
Authentication page.  
NIS Domain  
The NIS domain of the SLB branch office manager must be  
the same as the NIS domain of the NIS server.  
Broadcast for NIS  
Server  
If selected, the SLB device sends a broadcast datagram to  
find the NIS Server on the local network.  
NIS Master Server  
(required)  
The IP address or host name of the master server.  
NIS Slave  
The IP addresses or host names of up to five slave servers.  
Servers #1 -5  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Custom Menu  
If custom menus have been created you can assign a  
default custom menu to NIS users.  
Escape Sequence  
A single character or a two-character sequence that causes  
the SLB branch office manager to leave direct (interactive)  
mode. (To leave listen mode, press any key.)  
A suggested value is Esc+A (escape key, then uppercase  
"A" performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would  
specify this value as \x1bA, which is hexadecimal (\x)  
character 27 (1B) followed by an A.  
This setting allows the user to terminate the connect  
directcommand on the command line interface when the  
endpoint of the command is deviceport, tcp, or udp.  
Break  
Sequence  
A series of 1-10 characters users can enter on the command  
line interface to send a break signal to the external device. A  
suggested value is Esc+B (escape key, then uppercase “B”  
performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would specify  
this value as \x1bB, which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27  
(1B) followed by a B.  
Data Ports  
The ports users are able to monitor and interact with using  
the connect direct command. U and L denote the PC  
Card upper and lower slots.  
Listen Ports  
The ports users are able to monitor using the connect  
listencommand.  
Clear Port Buffers  
Access Outlets  
The ports whose port buffer users may clear using the set  
locallog clear command.  
The outlets the user may monitor and configure.  
3. In the User Rights section, select the user group to which NIS users will belong:  
Group  
Select the group to which the NIS users will belong:  
Default Users: This group has only the most basic rights.  
You can specify additional rights for the individual user .  
Power Users: This group has the same rights as Default  
Users plus Networking, Date/Time, Reboot & Shutdown,  
and Diagnostics & Reports.  
Administrators: This group has all possible rights.  
4. Select or clear the checkboxes for the following rights:  
Full Administrative  
Networking  
Right to add, update, and delete all editable fields.  
Right to enter Network settings.  
Services  
Right to enable and disable system logging, SSH and Telnet  
logins, SNMP, and SMTP.  
Date/Time  
Right to set the date and time.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Secure Lantronix  
Network  
Right to view and manage secure IT management units (e.g.,  
SLP power managers, Spiders, SLC console managers, SLB  
branch office managers) on the local subnet.  
Local Users  
Right to add or delete local users on the system.  
Remote  
Authentication  
Right to assign a remote user to a user group and assign a  
set of rights to the user.  
SSH Keys  
Right to set SSH keys for authenticating users.  
User Menus  
Right to create a custom user menu for the CLI for NIS users.  
Reboot &  
Shutdown  
Right to use the CLI or shut down the SLB branch office  
manager and then reboot it.  
Firmware &  
Configuration  
Right to upgrade the firmware on the unit and save or restore  
a configuration (all settings). Selecting this option  
automatically selects Reboot & Shutdown.  
Diagnostics &  
Reports  
Right to obtain diagnostic information and reports about the  
unit.  
Web Access  
Device Ports  
Right to access Web Manager.  
Right to enter device port settings.  
Right to enter modem settings for PC cards.  
Right to configure power outlets.  
PC Card  
Power Outlets  
5. Click the Apply button.  
Note: You must reboot the unit before your changes will take effect.  
NIS Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use NIS to authenticate users who  
log in via the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port:  
set nis <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
broadcast <enable|disable>  
clearports <Port List>  
dataports <Port List>  
domain <NIS Domain Name>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
listenports <Port List>  
master <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave1 <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave2 <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave3 <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave4 <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave5 <IP Address or Hostname>  
state <enable|disable>  
To set group and permissions for NIS users:  
set nis group <default|power|admin>  
To set permissions for NIS users not already defined by the user rights group:  
set nis permissions <Permission List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp,  
pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter abbreviation for a user  
right.  
To set a default custom menu for NIS users:  
set nis custommenu <Menu Name>  
To view NIS settings:  
show nis  
LDAP  
The system administrator can configure the SLB branch office manager to use LDAP to  
authenticate users attempting to log in using the Web, Telnet, SSH, or the console port.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
LDAP allows SLB users to authenticate using a wide variety of LDAP servers, such as  
OpenLDAP and Microsoft Active Directory. The LDAP implementation supports LDAP  
servers that do not allow anonymous queries.  
Users who are authenticated through LDAP are granted device port access through the  
port permissions on this page.  
All LDAP users are members of a group that has predefined user rights associated with  
it. You can add additional user rights that are not defined by the group.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use LDAP to authenticate users:  
1. Click the User Authentication tab and select LDAP. The following page displays.  
2. Enter the following:  
Enable LDAP  
Displays selected if you enabled this method on the first User  
Authentication page. If you want to set up this authentication  
method but not enable it immediately, clear the checkbox.  
Server  
Port  
The IP address or host name of the LDAP server.  
Number of the TCP port on the LDAP server to which the SLB  
branch office manager talks. The default is 389.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Base  
The name of the LDAP search base (e.g., dc=company, dc=com).  
May have up to 80 characters.  
Bind Name  
The name for a non-anonymous bind to an LDAP server. This item  
has the same format as LDAP Base. One example is  
cn=administrator,cn=Users,dc=domain,dc=com  
Bind Password and  
Retype Password  
Password for a non-anonymous bind. This entry is optional.  
Acceptable characters are a-z, A-Z, and 0-9.  
The maximum length is 127 characters.  
Active Directory  
Support  
Select to enable. Active Directory is a directory service from  
Microsoft that is a part of Windows 2000 and later versions of  
Windows. It is LDAP- and Kerberos- compliant. Disabled by  
default.  
Encrypt Messages  
Custom Menu  
Select to encrypt messages between the SLB branch office  
manager and the LDAP server. Disabled by default.  
If custom menus have been created (see Custom User Menus on  
page 174), you can assign a default custom menu to LDAP users.  
Escape Sequence  
A single character or a two-character sequence that causes the  
SLB branch office manager to leave direct (interactive) mode. (To  
leave listen mode, press any key.)  
A suggested value is Esc+A (escape key, then uppercase "A"  
performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would specify this  
value as \x1bA, which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27 (1B)  
followed by an A.  
This setting allows the user to terminate the connect direct  
command on the command line interface when the endpoint of the  
command is deviceport, tcp, or udp.  
Break  
Sequence  
A series of 1-10 characters users can enter on the command line  
interface to send a break signal to the external device. A suggested  
value is Esc+B (escape key, then uppercase “B” performed quickly  
but not simultaneously). You would specify this value as \x1bB,  
which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27 (1B) followed by a B.  
Data Ports  
The ports users are able to monitor and interact with using the  
connect direct command. U and L denote the PC Card upper  
and lower slots.  
Listen Port  
The ports users are able to monitor using the connect listen  
command.  
Clear Port Buffers  
The ports whose port buffer users may clear using the set  
locallog clear command.  
Access Outlets  
The outlets the user may monitor and configure.  
3. In the User Rights section, select the user group to which LDAP users will belong:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Group  
Select the group to which the LDAP users will belong:  
Default Users: This group has only the most basic rights. You can  
specify additional rights for the individual user.  
Power Users: This group has the same rights as Default Users  
plus Networking, Date/Time, Reboot & Shutdown, and  
Diagnostics & Reports.  
Administrators: This group has all possible rights.  
4. Select or clear the checkboxes for the following rights:  
Full Administrative  
Networking  
Right to add, update, and delete all editable fields.  
Right to enter Network settings.  
Services  
Right to enable and disable system logging, SSH and Telnet logins,  
SNMP, and SMTP.  
Secure Lantronix  
Network  
Right to view and manage secure IT management units (e.g., SLP  
power managers, Spiders, SLB branch office managers) on the  
local subnet.  
Date/Time  
Right to set the date and time.  
Local Users  
Right to add or delete local users on the system.  
Remote  
Authentication  
Right to assign a remote user to a user group and assign a set of  
rights to the user.  
SSH Keys  
Right to set SSH keys for authenticating users.  
User Menus  
Right to create a custom user menu for the CLI for LDAP users.  
Reboot &  
Shutdown  
Right to use the CLI or shut down the SLB branch office manager  
and then reboot it.  
Firmware &  
Configuration  
Right to upgrade the firmware on the unit and save or restore a  
configuration (all settings). Selecting this option automatically  
selects Reboot & Shutdown.  
Diagnostics &  
Reports  
Right to obtain diagnostic information and reports about the unit.  
Web Access  
Device Ports  
Right to access Web Manager.  
Right to enter device port settings.  
Right to enter modem settings for PC cards.  
Right to configure power outlets.  
PC Card  
Power Outlets  
5. Click the Apply button.  
Note: You must reboot the unit before your changes will take effect.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
LDAP Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use LDAP to authenticate users  
who log in via the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port:  
set ldap <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
adsupport <enable|disable>  
Enables or disables active directory.  
base <LDAP Base>  
bindname <Bind Name>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
dataports <Ports List>  
listenports <Port List>  
clearports <Port List>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
bindpassword <Bind Password>  
encrypt <enable|disable>  
port <TCP Port>  
Default is 389.  
server <IP Address or Hostname>  
state <enable|disable>  
To set user group and permissions for LDAP users:  
group <default|power|admin>  
To set permissions for LDAP users not already defined by the user rights group:  
permissions <Permission List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp,  
pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter abbreviation for a user  
right.  
To set a default custom menu for LDAP users:  
custommenu <Menu Name>  
To view LDAP settings:  
show ldap  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
RADIUS  
The system administrator can configure the SLB branch office manager to use RADIUS  
to authenticate users attempting to log in using the Web, Telnet, SSH, or the console  
port.  
Users who are authenticated through RADIUS are granted device port access through  
the port permissions on this page.  
All RADIUS users are members of a group that has predefined user rights associated  
with it. You can add additional user rights that are not defined by the group.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use RADIUS to authenticate users:  
1. Click the User Authentication tab and select RADIUS. The following page  
displays.  
2. Enter the following:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
Enable RADIUS  
Displays selected if you enabled this method on the User  
Authentication page. If you want to set up this authentication  
method but not enable it immediately, clear the checkbox.  
Note: You can enable RADIUS here or on the first User  
Authentication page. If you enable RADIUS here, it  
automatically displays at the end of the order of precedence  
on the User Authentication page.  
RADIUS Server #1  
IP address or hostname of the primary RADIUS server. This  
RADIUS server may be a proxy for SecurID.  
SecurID is a two-factor authentication method based on the  
user's SecurID token and pin number. The SecurID token  
displays a string of digits called a token code that changes  
once a minute (some tokens are set to change codes every  
30 seconds).  
Server #1 Port  
Number of the TCP port on the RADIUS server used for the  
RADIUS service. If you do not specify an optional port, the  
SLB branch office manager uses the default RADIUS port  
(1812).  
Server #1 Secret  
Text that serves as a shared secret between a RADIUS client  
and the server (SLB device). The shared secret is used to  
encrypt a password sent between the client and the server.  
May have up to 128 characters.  
RADIUS Server #2  
Server #2 Port  
IP address or host name of the secondary RADIUS server.  
This server can be used as a SecurID proxy.  
Number of the TCP port on the RADIUS server used for the  
RADIUS service. If you do not specify an optional port, the  
SLB branch office manager uses the default RADIUS port  
(1812).  
Server #2 Secret  
Text that serves as a shared secret between a RADIUS client  
and the server (SLB device). The shared secret is used to  
encrypt a password sent between the client and the server.  
May have up to 128 characters.  
Timeout  
The number of seconds (1-30) after which the connection  
attempt times out. The default is 30 seconds.  
Custom Menu  
Escape Sequence  
If custom menus have been created, you can assign a default  
custom menu to RADIUS users.  
A single character or a two-character sequence that causes  
the SLB branch office manager to leave direct (interactive)  
mode. (To leave listen mode, press any key.)  
A suggested value is Esc+A (escape key, then uppercase  
"A" performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would  
specify this value as \x1bA, which is hexadecimal (\x)  
character 27 (1B) followed by an A.  
This setting allows the user to terminate the connect  
directcommand on the command line interface when the  
endpoint of the command is deviceport, tcp, or udp.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Break  
Sequence  
A series of 1-10 characters users can enter on the command  
line interface to send a break signal to the external device. A  
suggested value is Esc+B (escape key, then uppercase “B”  
performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would specify  
this value as \x1bB, which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27  
(1B) followed by a B.  
Data Ports  
The ports users are able to monitor and interact with using  
the connect direct command. U and L denote the PC  
Card upper and lower slots.  
Listen Port  
The ports users are able to monitor using the connect  
listencommand.  
Clear Port Buffers  
Access Outlets  
The ports whose port buffer users may clear using the set  
locallog clear command.  
The power outlets users may monitor and configure.  
Note: Older RADIUS servers may use 1645 as the default port. Check your  
RADIUS server configuration.  
3. In the User Rights section, select the user group to which RADIUS users will  
belong.  
Group  
Select the group to which the RADIUS users will belong:  
Default Users: This group has only the most basic rights.  
You can specify additional rights for the individual user.  
Power Users: This group has the same rights as Default  
Users plus Networking, Date/Time, Reboot & Shutdown,  
and Diagnostics & Reports.  
Administrators: This group has all possible rights.  
4. Select or clear the checkboxes for the following rights:  
Full Administrative  
Networking  
Right to add, update, and delete all editable fields.  
Right to enter Network settings.  
Services  
Right to enable and disable system logging, SSH and Telnet  
logins, SNMP, and SMTP.  
Secure Lantronix  
Network  
Right to view and manage secure IT management units (e.g.,  
SLP power managers, Spiders, SLB branch office managers)  
on the local subnet.  
Date/Time  
Right to set the date and time.  
Local Users  
Right to add or delete local users on the system.  
Remote  
Authentication  
Right to assign a remote user to a user group and assign a  
set of rights to the user.  
SSH Keys  
Right to set SSH keys for authenticating users.  
User Menus  
Right to create a custom user menu for the CLI for NIS users.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Reboot &  
Shutdown  
Right to use the CLI or shut down the SLB branch office  
manager and then reboot it.  
Firmware &  
Configuration  
Right to upgrade the firmware on the unit and save or restore  
a configuration (all settings). Selecting this option  
automatically selects Reboot & Shutdown.  
Diagnostics &  
Reports  
Right to obtain diagnostic information and reports about the  
unit.  
Web Access  
Device Ports  
Right to access Web Manager.  
Right to enter device port settings.  
Right to enter modem settings for PC cards.  
Right to configure power outlets.  
PC Card  
Power Outlets  
5. Click the Apply button.  
Note: You must reboot the unit before your changes will take effect.  
RADIUS Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use RADIUS to authenticate users  
who log in via the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port:  
set radius <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
clearports <Port List>  
dataports <Port List>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
listenports <Port List>  
state <enable|disable>  
To identify the RADIUS server(s), the text secret, and the number of the TCP port  
on the RADIUS server:  
set radius server <1|2> host <IP Address or Hostname> secret  
<Secret> [port <TCP Port>]  
The default port is 1812.  
To set the number of seconds after which the connection attempt times out:  
set radius timeout <disable|1-30>  
May be 1-30 seconds.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
To set user group and permissions for RADIUS users:  
set radius group <default|power|admin>  
To set permissions for RADIUS users not already defined by the user rights group:  
set radius permissions <Permission List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp,  
pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter abbreviation for a user  
right.  
To set a default custom menu for RADIUS users:  
set radius custommenu <Menu Name>  
To view RADIUS settings:  
show radius  
Kerberos  
Kerberos is a network authentication protocol that provides strong authentication for  
client/server applications by using secret-key cryptography.  
The system administrator can configure the SLB branch office manager to use Kerberos  
to authenticate users attempting to log in using the Web, Telnet, SSH, or the console  
port.  
Users who are authenticated through Kerberos are granted device port access through  
the port permissions on this page.  
All Kerberos users are members of a group that has predefined user rights associated  
with it. You can add additional user rights that are not defined by the group.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use Kerberos to authenticate  
users:  
1. Click the User Authentication tab and select the Kerberos option. The following  
page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
2. Enter the following:  
Displays selected if you enabled this method on the User  
Authentication page. If you want to set up this authentication  
method but not enable it immediately, clear the checkbox.  
Enable Kerberos  
Note: You can enable Kerberos here or on the first User  
Authentication page. If you enable Kerberos here, it automatically  
displays at the end of the order of precedence on the User  
Authentication page.  
Enter the name of the logical network served by a single Kerberos  
database and a set of Key Distribution Centers. Usually, realm  
names are all uppercase letters to differentiate the realm from the  
Internet domain. Realm is similar in concept to an NT domain.  
Realm  
KDC  
A key distribution center (KDC) is a server that issues Kerberos  
tickets. A ticket is a temporary set of electronic credentials that  
verify the identity of a client for a particular service.  
Enter the KDC in the fully qualified domain format (FQDN). An  
example is SLB.local.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Enter the IP address of the Key Distribution Center (KDC).  
KDC IP Address  
KDC Port  
Port on the KDC listening for requests. Enter an integer with a  
maximum value of 65535. The default is 88.  
Custom Menu  
If custom menus have been created, you can assign a default  
custom menu to RADIUS users.  
Escape Sequence  
A single character or a two-character sequence that causes the  
SLB branch office manager to leave direct (interactive) mode. (To  
leave listen mode, press any key.)  
A suggested value is Esc+A (escape key, then uppercase "A"  
performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would specify this  
value as \x1bA, which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27 (1B)  
followed by an A.  
This setting allows the user to terminate the connect direct  
command on the command line interface when the endpoint of the  
command is deviceport, tcp, or udp.  
Break  
Sequence  
A series of 1-10 characters users can enter on the command line  
interface to send a break signal to the external device. A  
suggested value is Esc+B (escape key, then uppercase “B”  
performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would specify this  
value as \x1bB, which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27 (1B)  
followed by a B.  
Use LDAP  
Data Ports  
Indicate whether Kerberos should rely on LDAP to look up  
user IDs and Group IDs. This setting is disabled by default.  
Note: Make sure to configure LDAP if you select this option.  
The ports users are able to monitor and interact with using the  
connect direct command. U and L denote the PC Card  
upper and lower slots.  
Listen Port  
The ports users are able to monitor using the connect listen  
command.  
Clear Port Buffers  
Access Outlets  
The ports whose port buffer users may clear using the set  
locallog clear command.  
The power outlets users may monitor and configure.  
3. In the User Rights section, select the user group to which Kerberos users will  
belong.  
Group  
Select the group to which the Kerberos users will belong:  
Default Users: This group has only the most basic rights.  
You can specify additional rights for the individual user.  
Power Users: This group has the same rights as Default  
Users plus Networking, Date/Time, Reboot & Shutdown,  
and Diagnostics & Reports.  
Administrators: This group has all possible rights.  
4. Select or clear the checkboxes for the following rights:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Full Administrative  
Networking  
Right to add, update, and delete all editable fields.  
Right to enter Network settings.  
Services  
Right to enable and disable system logging, SSH and Telnet  
logins, SNMP, and SMTP.  
Secure Lantronix  
Network  
Right to view and manage secure IT management units (e.g.,  
SLP power managers, Spiders, SLB branch office managers)  
on the local subnet.  
Date/Time  
Right to set the date and time.  
Local Users  
Right to add or delete local users on the system.  
Remote  
Authentication  
Right to assign a remote user to a user group and assign a  
set of rights to the user.  
SSH Keys  
Right to set SSH keys for authenticating users.  
User Menus  
Right to create a custom user menu for the CLI for Kerberos  
users.  
Reboot &  
Shutdown  
Right to use the CLI or shut down the SLB branch office  
manager and then reboot it.  
Firmware &  
Configuration  
Right to upgrade the firmware on the unit and save or restore  
a configuration (all settings). Selecting this option  
automatically selects Reboot & Shutdown.  
Diagnostics &  
Reports  
Right to obtain diagnostic information and reports about the  
unit.  
Web Access  
Device Ports  
Right to access Web Manager.  
Right to enter device port settings.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
PC Card  
Right to enter modem settings for PC cards.  
Right to configure power outlets.  
Power Outlets  
5. Click the Apply button.  
Note: You must reboot the unit before your changes will take effect.  
Kerberos Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use Kerberos to authenticate users  
who log in via the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port:  
set kerberos <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
clearports <Port List>  
dataports <Port List>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
ipaddr <Key Distribution Center IP Address>  
kdc <Key Distribution Center>  
listenports <Port List>  
port <Key Distribution Center TCP Port>  
realm <Kerberos Realm>  
state <enable|disable>  
useldapforlookup <enable|disable>  
To set user group and permissions for Kerberos users:  
set kerberos group <default|power|admin>  
To set permissions for Kerberos users not already defined by the user rights  
group:  
set kerberos permissions <Permission List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp,  
pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter abbreviation for a user  
right.  
To set a default custom menu for Kerberos users:  
set kerberos custommenu <Menu Name>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
To view Kerberos settings:  
show kerberos  
TACACS+  
Similar to RADIUS, the main function of TACACS+ is to perform authentication for remote  
access. The SLB branch office manager supports the TACACS+ protocol (not the older  
TACACS or XTACACS protocols).  
The system administrator can configure the SLB device to use TACACS+ to authenticate  
users attempting to log in using the Web, Telnet, SSH, or the console port.  
Users who are authenticated through Kerberos are granted device port access through  
the port permissions on this page.  
All Kerberos users are members of a group that has predefined user rights associated  
with it. You can add additional user rights that are not defined by the group.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use TACACS+ to authenticate  
users:  
1. Click the TACACS+ tab and select TACACS+. The following page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
2. Enter the following:  
Enable TACACS+  
Displays selected if you enabled this method on the User  
Authentication page. If you want to set up this authentication  
method but not enable it immediately, clear the checkbox.  
You can enable TACACS+ here or on the first User Authentication  
page. If you enable TACACS+ here, it automatically displays at  
the end of the order of precedence on the User Authentication  
page.  
TACACS+ Servers  
1-3  
IP address or host name of up to three TACACS+ servers.  
Secret  
Shared secret for message encryption between the SLB branch  
office manager and the TACACS+ server. Enter an alphanumeric  
secret of up to 127 characters.  
Encrypt Messages  
Custom Menu  
Select the checkbox to encrypt messages between the SLB  
device and the TACACS+ server. Selected by default.  
If custom menus have been created (see the User Guide), you  
can assign a default custom menu to TACACS+ users.  
Escape Sequence  
A single character or a two-character sequence that causes the  
SLB branch office manager to leave direct (interactive) mode. (To  
leave listen mode, press any key.)  
A suggested value is Esc+A (escape key, then uppercase "A"  
performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would specify this  
value as \x1bA, which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27 (1B)  
followed by an A.  
This setting allows the user to terminate the connect direct  
command on the command line interface when the endpoint of the  
command is deviceport, tcp, or udp.  
Break  
Sequence  
A series of 1-10 characters users can enter on the command line  
interface to send a break signal to the external device. A  
suggested value is Esc+B (escape key, then uppercase “B”  
performed quickly but not simultaneously). You would specify this  
value as \x1bB, which is hexadecimal (\x) character 27 (1B)  
followed by a B.  
Data Ports  
The ports users are able to monitor and interact with using the  
connect direct command. U and L denote the upper and  
lower slots of the PC Card.  
Listen Port  
The ports users are able to monitor using the connect listen  
command.  
Clear Port Buffers  
Access Outlets  
The ports whose port buffer users may clear using the set  
locallog clear command.  
The power outlets users may monitor and configure.  
3. In the User Rights section, select the user group to which TACACS+ users will  
belong.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Group  
Select the group to which the TACACS+ users will belong:  
Default Users: This group has only the most basic rights.  
You can specify additional rights for the individual user.  
Power Users: This group has the same rights as Default  
Users plus Networking, Date/Time, Reboot & Shutdown,  
and Diagnostics & Reports.  
Administrators: This group has all possible rights.  
4. Select or clear the checkboxes for the following rights:  
Full Administrative  
Networking  
Right to add, update, and delete all editable fields.  
Right to enter Network settings.  
Services  
Right to enable and disable system logging, SSH and Telnet  
logins, SNMP, and SMTP.  
Secure Lantronix  
Network  
Right to view and manage secure IT management units (e.g.,  
SLP power managers, Spiders, SLB branch office managers)  
on the local subnet.  
Date/Time  
Right to set the date and time.  
Local Users  
Right to add or delete local users on the system.  
Remote  
Authentication  
Right to assign a remote user to a user group and assign a  
set of rights to the user.  
SSH Keys  
Right to set SSH keys for authenticating users.  
User Menus  
Right to create a custom user menu for the CLI for TACACS+  
users.  
Reboot &  
Shutdown  
Right to use the CLI or shut down the SLB device and then  
reboot it.  
Firmware &  
Configuration  
Right to upgrade the firmware on the unit and save or restore  
a configuration (all settings). Selecting this option  
automatically selects Reboot & Shutdown.  
Diagnostics &  
Reports  
Right to obtain diagnostic information and reports about the  
unit.  
Web Access  
Device Ports  
Right to access Web Manager.  
Right to enter device port settings.  
Right to enter modem settings for PC cards.  
Right to configure power outlets.  
PC Card  
Power Outlets  
5. Click the Apply button.  
Note: You must reboot the unit before your changes will take effect.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
TACACS+ Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use TACACS+ to authenticate  
users who log in via the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port:  
set tacacs+ <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
clearports <Port List>  
dataports <Port List>  
encrypt <enable|disable>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
listenports <Port List>  
secret <TACACS+ Secret>  
server1 <IP Address or Name>  
server2 <IP Address or Name>  
server3 <IP Address or Name>  
state <enable|disable>  
To set user group and permissions for TACACS+ users:  
set tacacs+ group <default|power|admin>  
To set permissions for TACACS+ users not already defined by the user rights  
group:  
set tacacs+ permissions <Permission List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp,  
pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter abbreviation for a user  
right.  
To set a default custom menu for TACACS+ users:  
set tacacs+ custommenu <Menu Name>  
To view TACACS+ settings:  
show tacacs+  
SSH Keys  
The SLB branch office manager can import and export SSH keys to facilitate shared key  
authentication for all incoming and outgoing SSH connections. By using a public/private  
key pair, a user can access multiple hosts with a single passphrase, or, if a passphrase is  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
11: User Authentication  
not used, a user can access multiple hosts without entering a password. In either case,  
the authentication is protected against security attacks because both the public key and  
the private key are required to authenticate. For both imported and exported SSH keys,  
the SLB device supports both RSA and DSA keys, and can import and export keys in  
OpenSSH and SECSH formats. Imported and exported keys are saved with the SLB  
branch office manager configuration, and the administrator has the option of retaining the  
SSH keys during a reset to factory defaults.  
The SLB device can also update the SSH RSA1, RSA and DSA host keys that the SSH  
server uses with site-specific host keys or reset them to the default values.  
Imported Keys  
Imported SSH keys must be associated with an SLB local user. The key can be  
generated on host "MyHost" for user "MyUser," and when the key is imported into the  
SLB branch office manager, it must be associated with either "MyUser" (if "MyUser" is an  
existing SLB local user) or an alternate SLB local user. The public key file can be  
imported via SCP or FTP; once imported, you can view or delete the public key. Any SSH  
connection into the SLB branch office manager from the designated host/user  
combination uses the SSH key for authentication.  
Exported Keys  
The SLB device can generate SSH keys for SSH connections out of the SLB for any SLB  
user. The SLB branch office manager retains both the private and public key on the SLB  
device, and makes the public key available for export via SCP, FTP, or copy and paste.  
The name of the key is used to generate the name of the public key file that is exported  
(for example, <keyname>.pub), and the exported keys are organized by user and key  
name. Once a key is generated and exported, you can delete the key or view the public  
portion. Any SSH connection out of the SLB branch office manager for the designated  
host/user combination uses the SSH key for authentication.  
To configure the SLB branch office manager to use SSH keys to authenticate  
users:  
1. From the main menu, select User Authentication – SSH Keys. The following  
page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
11: User Authentication  
2. Enter the following:  
Imported Keys (SSH In)  
Host & User Associated with Key  
These entries are required in the following cases:  
The imported key file does not contain the host that the user will be making an  
SSH connection from, or  
The SLB local user login for the connection is different from the user name the  
key was generated from or is not included in the imported key file.  
If either of these conditions is true, or the imported file is in SECSH format, you must  
specify the user and host. The following is an example of a public key file that includes  
the user and host:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAABIwAAAEEApUHCX9EWsHt+jmUGXa1YC3us  
ABYxIXUhSU1N+NU9HNaUADUFfd8LYz8/gUnUSH4Ksm8GRT7/8/Sn9jCVfGPh  
UQ== asallaway@winserver  
Host  
User  
Host name or IP address from which the SSH connections to the  
SLB branch office manager will be made.  
The User ID of the user being given secure access to the SLB  
device.  
Host & Login for Import  
Import via  
Select SCP or FTP as the method for importing the SSH keys.  
SCP is the default.  
Filename  
Host  
Name of the public key file (for example, mykey.pub). May contain  
multiple keys.  
IP address of the remote server from which to SCP or FTP the  
public key file.  
Path  
Optional pathname to the public key file.  
User ID to use to SCP or FTP the file.  
Password to use to SCP or FTP the file.  
Login  
Password/Retype  
Password  
Exported Keys (SSH Out)  
Export  
Enables you to export created public keys. Select one of the  
following:  
New Key for User: Enables you to create a new key for a user  
and export the public key in a file..  
All Previously Created Keys: Does not create any keys, but  
exports all previously created public keys in one file.  
User  
User ID of the person given secure access to the remote server.  
Key Name  
Name of the key. This will generate the public key filename (e.g.,  
<keyname>.pub).  
Key Type  
Select either the RSA or the DSA encryption standard. RSA is the  
default.  
Number of Bits  
Select the number of bits in the key (512 or 1024). The default is  
512.  
Passphrase/Retype  
Passphrase  
Optionally, enter a passphrase associated with the key. The  
passphrase may have up to 50 characters. The passphrase is an  
optional password that can be associated with an SSH key. It is  
unique to each user and to each key.  
SECSH Format  
Indicate whether the keys will be exported in SECSH format (by  
default the key is exported in OpenSSH format).  
Public Key  
Filename  
Filename of the public host key.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Host and Login for Export  
Export via  
Select the method (SCP, FTP, or Cut and Paste) of exporting the  
key to the remote server. Cut and Paste, the default, requires no  
other parameters for export.  
Host  
Path  
Login  
IP address of the remote server to which the SLB branch office  
manager will SCP or FTP the public key file.  
Optional path of the file on the host to SCP or FTP the public key  
too.  
User ID to use to SCP or FTP the public key file.  
Password to use to SCP or FTP the public key file.  
Password/Retype  
Password  
To view or delete a key:  
1. Select the key from the appropriate table. The View and Delete buttons become  
active.  
2. To view the key, click the View button. A pop-up page displays the key.  
3. To delete the key, click the Delete button.  
To view, reset, or import SSH RSA1, RSA, And DSA host keys:  
1. On the User Authentication – SSH Keys page, click the SSH Server/Host Keys  
link at the top right. The following page displays the current host keys. In the  
example below, the current keys are the defaults.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
2. View or enter the following:  
Reset to Default  
Host Key  
Select the All Keys checkbox to reset all default  
key(s), or select one or more checkboxes to reset  
defaults for RSA1, RSA, or DSA keys. All  
checkboxes are unselected by default.  
Import Host Key  
Type  
To import a site-specific host key, select the  
checkbox. Unselected by default.  
From the drop-down list, select the type of host  
key to import.  
Import via  
From the drop-down list, select the method of  
importing the host key (SCP or SFTP). The  
default is SCP.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Public Key  
Filename  
Filename of the public host key.  
Filename of the private host key.  
Private Key  
Filename  
Host  
Path  
Login  
Host name or IPaddress of the host from which to  
import the key.  
Path of the directory where the host key will be  
stored.  
User ID to use to SCP or SFTP the file.  
Password to use to SCP or SFTP the file.  
Password & Retype  
Password  
3. Click the Apply button.  
4. Repeat steps 2-3 for each key you want to import.  
5. To return to the SSH Keys page, click the Back to SSH Keys link.  
SSH Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
To import an SSH key:  
set sshkey import <ftp|scp> <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
[keyhost <SSH Key IP Address or Name>]  
[keyuser <SSH Key User>]  
[path <Path to Public Key File>]  
file <Public Key File>  
host <IP Address or Name>  
login <User Login>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
To export a key:  
set sshkey export <ftp|scp|copypaste> <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
[format <openssh|secsh>]  
[host <IP Address or Name>]  
[login <User Login>]  
[path <Path to Copy Key>]  
bits <512|1024>  
keyname <SSH Key Name>  
keyuser <SSH Key User>  
type <rsa|dsa>  
To export the public keys of all previously created SSH keys:  
set sshkey all export <ftp|scp|copypaste> [pubfile <Public Key  
File>] [host <IP Address or Name>] [login <User Login>] [path  
<Path to Copy Keys>]  
To delete a key:  
set sshkey delete <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
keyhost <SSH Key Host>  
keyname <SSH Key Name>  
keyuser <SSH Key User>  
Note: Specify the key user and key host to delete an imported key;  
specify the keyuser and keyname to delete an exported key.  
To import an SLB host key or to reset a SLB host key to the default:  
set sshkey server import type <rsa1|rsa|dsa> via <sftp|scp>  
pubfile <Public Key File> privfile <Private Key File>  
host <IP Address or Name> login <User Login> [path  
<Path to Key File>]  
To reset defaults for all or selected host keys:  
set sshkey server reset [type <all|rsa1|rsa|dsa>]  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
To display SSH keys that have been imported:  
show sshkey import <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
[keyhost <SSH Key IP Address or Name>]  
[keyuser <SSH Key User>]  
[viewkey <enable|disable>]  
To display SSH keys that have been exported:  
show sshkey export <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
[keyhost <SSH Key IP Address or Name>]  
[keyuser <SSH Key User>]  
[viewkey <enable|disable>]  
To display host keys (public key only):  
show sshkey server [type <all|rsa1|rsa|dsa>]  
6. Click the Apply button. New entries display in the Imported SSH Keys table and  
Exported SSH Keys table, as applicable.  
Custom User Menus  
Local and remote users can have a custom user menu as their command line interface  
rather than the standard command set. Instead of typing each command, the user enters  
the number associated with the command. Each command can also have a nickname  
that can display in the menu instead of the command.  
From the current menu, a user can display another menu, thus allowing menus to be  
nested. The special command showmenu <Menu Name>displays a specified menu.  
The special command returnmenuredisplays the parent menu if the current menu was  
displayed from a showmenu command.  
The user with appropriate rights creates and manages custom user menus from the  
command line interface, but can assign a custom user menu to a user from either the  
command line or the web interface.  
Custom User Menu Commands  
When creating a custom user menu, note the following limitations:  
Maximum of 20 custom user menus  
Maximum of 50 commands per custom user menu (logoutis always the last  
command)  
Maximum of 15 characters for menu names  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
11: User Authentication  
Maximum of five nested menus can be called.  
No syntax checking (Enter each command correctly.)  
To assign a custom user menu to a local or remote user:  
set localusers add|edit <User Login> menu <Menu Name>  
To create a new custom user menu or add a command to an existing custom user  
menu:  
set menu add <Menu Name> [command <Command Number>]  
To change a command or nickname within an existing custom user menu:  
set menu edit <Menu Name> command <Command Number>  
set menu edit <Menu Name> nickname <Command Number>  
To set the optional title for a menu:  
set menu edit <Menu Name> title <Menu Title>  
To enable or disable the display of command nicknames instead of commands:  
set menu edit <Menu Name> shownicknames <enable|disable>  
To enable or disable the redisplay of the menu before each prompt:  
set menu edit <Menu Name> redisplaymenu  
<enable|disable>  
To delete a custom user menu or one command within a custom user menu:  
set menu delete <Menu Name> [command <Command Number>]  
To view a list of all menu names or all commands for a specific menu:  
show menu <all|Menu Name>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Example  
The system administrator creates two custom user menus, with menu1 having a nested  
menu (menu2):  
[SLB]> set menu add menu1  
Enter optional menu title (<return> for none): Menu1 Title  
Specify nickname for each command? [no] y  
Enter each command, up to 50 commands ('logout' is always the last command).  
Press <return> when the menu command set is complete.  
Command #1: connect direct deviceport 1  
Nickname #1: connect Port-1  
Command #2: connect direct deviceport 2  
Nickname #2: connect Port-2  
Command #3: showmenu menu2  
Warning: menu 'menu2' does not exist.  
Nickname #3: menu2  
Command #4:  
Command #4: logout  
Nickname #4: log off  
Custom User Menu settings successfully updated.  
[SLB]> set menu add menu2  
Enter optional menu title (<return> for none): Menu2 Title  
Specify nickname for each command? [no]  
Enter each command, up to 50 commands ('logout' is always the last command).  
Press <return> when the menu command set is complete.  
Command #1: connect direct deviceport 3  
Command #2: connect direct deviceport 4  
Command #3: show datetime  
Command #4: returnmenu  
Command #5:  
Command #5: logout  
Custom User Menu settings successfully updated.  
[SLB]> show menu all  
___Custom User Menus___________________________________________________________  
menu1  
menu2  
[SLB]> show menu menu1  
___Custom User Menus___________________________________________________________  
Menu: menu1  
Title: Menu1 Title  
Show Nicknames: enabled  
Redisplay Menu: disabled  
Command  
1: connect direct deviceport 1  
Nickname 1: connect Port-1  
Command  
2: connect direct deviceport 2  
Nickname 2: connect Port-2  
Command  
Nickname 3: menu2  
Command 4: logout  
3: showmenu menu2  
Nickname 4: log off  
[SLB]> show menu menu2  
_
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11: User Authentication  
__Custom User Menus___________________________________________________________  
Menu: menu2  
Title: Menu2 Title  
Show Nicknames: disabled  
Redisplay Menu: disabled  
Command  
1: connect direct deviceport 3  
Nickname 1: <none>  
Command  
2: connect direct deviceport 4  
Nickname 2: <none>  
Command  
3: show datetime  
Nickname 3: <none>  
Command  
4: returnmenu  
Nickname 4: <none>  
Command  
5: logout  
Nickname 5: <none>  
The system administrator 4 configures local user 'john' to use custom menu 'menu1':  
[SLB]> set localusers edit john custommenu menu1  
Local users settings successfully updated.  
[SLB]> show localusers user john  
___Current Local Users Settings________________________________________________  
Login: john  
Password: <set> UID: 101  
Listen Ports: 1-32  
Data Ports: 1-32  
Clear Ports: 1-32  
Escape Sequence: \x1bA Break Sequence: \x1bB  
Custom Menu: menu1  
Allow Dialback: disabled  
Dialback Number: <none>  
User 'john ' logs into the command line interface, initially sees menu1, executes the  
command to jump to nested menu menu2, and then returns to menu1:  
Welcome to the SLB Branch Office Manager  
Model Number: SLB32  
For a list of commands, type 'help'.  
[Enter 1-4]> help  
Menu1 Title  
-------------------------------------------------------------------------  
1) connect Port-1  
2) connect Port-2  
[Enter 1-4]> 3  
3) menu2  
4) log off  
Executing: showmenu menu2  
[Enter 1-5]> help  
Menu2 Title  
-----------  
1) connect direct deviceport 3  
2) connect direct deviceport 4  
3) show datetime  
4) returnmenu  
5) logout  
[Enter 1-5]> 3  
Executing: show datetime  
Date/Time: Tue Sep 7 19:13:35 2004  
Timezone: UTC  
[Enter 1-5]> 4  
Executing: returnmenu  
[Enter 1-4]> help  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11: User Authentication  
Menu1 Title  
-------------------------------------------------------------------------  
1) connect Port-1  
2) connect Port-2  
[Enter 1-4]> 4  
3) menu2  
4) log off  
Executing: logout  
Logging out...  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
The system administrator performs maintenance activities and operates the SLB branch  
office manager using the options for the Maintenance tab and additional commands on  
the command line interface.  
SLB Maintenance  
The Firmware & Configurations page allows the system administrator to:  
Configure the FTP, SFTP, or TFTP server that will be used to provide  
firmware updates and save/restore configurations. (TFTP is only used for  
firmware updates.)  
Set up the location or method that will be used to save or restore  
configurations (default, FTP, SFTP, NFS, CIFS, or PCCARD). Update the  
version of the firmware running on the SLB branch office manager.  
Save a snapshot of all settings on the SLB device (save a configuration).  
Restore the configuration, either to a previously saved configuration, or to the  
factory defaults.  
View and terminate current web sessions.  
Import a site-specific SSL certificate  
For dual boot SLB devices, view the firmware version on each boot bank,  
select the bank to boot from, and copy the contents of one boot bank to the  
other.  
Enable an iGoogle gadget that displays the status of ports on multiple SLB  
branch office managers.  
To configure settings:  
1. Click the Maintenance tab. The Firmware & Configurations page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
12: Maintenance and Operation  
2. Enter the following:  
General  
Reboot  
Select this option to reboot the SLB branch office manager  
immediately. The default is No.  
Note: The front panel LCD displays the “Rebooting the SLB”  
message, and the normal boot sequence occurs.  
Shutdown  
Select this option to shut down the SLB device. The default is  
No.  
Welcome Banner  
The text to display on the command line interface before the  
user logs in. Welcome to the SLB is the default.  
Note: To create more lines use the \n character sequence.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
Login Banner  
Logout Banner  
Web Timeout  
The text to display on the command line interface after the user  
logs in. Default is blank.  
Note: To create more lines, use the \n character sequence.  
The text to display on the command line interface after the user  
logs out. Default is blank.  
Note: To create more lines use, the \n character sequence.  
Number of minutes (5-120) after which the SLB web session  
times out. The default is 5. To avoid timeouts, select No.  
If the session times out, refresh the browser page and enter  
your user id and password to open another web session.  
Note: If you close the browser without logging off the SLB  
branch office manager first, you will have to wait for the timeout  
time to expire. You can also end a web session by using the  
admin web terminate command at the CLI or by asking  
your system administrator to terminate your active web session.  
To view or terminate current web sessions, click the Web  
To view, import, or reset the SSL Certificate, click the SSL  
Enable iGoogle  
Gadget Web  
Content  
Select the check box to enable an SLB iGoogle gadget. The  
iGoogle gadget allows an iGoogle user to view the port status of  
many SLB devices on one web page. (See iGoogle Gadgets on  
SLB Firmware  
Update Firmware  
To update the SLB firmware, select the checkbox. If you select  
this option, the SLB reboots after you apply the update.  
To view a log of all prior firmware updates, click the Firmware  
Update Log link.  
Note: For dual boot SLB branch office managers, the non-  
active boot bank is updated during the firmware update, without  
requiring a reboot. The configuration on the current boot bank  
may optionally be copied to the non-active boot bank during the  
firmware update.  
Load Firmware via  
From the drop-down list, select the method of loading the  
firmware. Options are FTP, TFTP, HTTPS and SFTP (Secure  
FTP). FTP is the default.  
If you select HTTPS, the Upload File link becomes active.  
Select the link to open a popup window that allows you to  
browse to a firmware update file to upload.  
Firmware Filename  
Key  
The name of the firmware update file downloaded from the  
Lantronix web site.  
A key for validating the firmware file. The key is provided with  
the firmware file (32 hex characters).  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
Boot Banks  
Bank 1  
Version of SLB firmware in bank 1.  
Note: The word "current" displays next to the bank the SLB  
branch office manager booted from.  
Bank 2  
Version of SLB firmware in bank 2.  
Next Boot Bank  
Current setting for bank to boot from at next reboot.  
If desired, select the alternate bank to boot from at next reboot.  
Switch to Bank  
Copy configuration  
from Bank 1 to  
Bank 2 during  
If checked, will copy the configuration from the current bank to  
the bank being updated. The two numbers are automatically  
generated so that the first number is the current bank.  
firmware update  
Copy contents of  
Bank 1 to Bank 2  
If checked, enables you to copy the current boot bank to the  
alternate boot bank. This process takes a few minutes to  
complete.  
FTP/TFTP/SFTP  
Server  
The IP address or host name of the server used for obtaining  
updates and saving or restoring configurations. May have up to  
64 alphanumeric characters; may include hyphens and  
underscores.  
Path  
The default path on the server for obtaining firmware update  
files and getting and putting configuration save files.  
Login  
The userid for accessing the FTP server. May be blank.  
The FTP user password.  
Password /Retype  
Password  
Configuration Management  
Configuration  
Management  
From the option list, select one of the following:  
No Save/Restore: Does not save or restore a configuration.  
Save Configuration: Saves all settings to file, which can be  
backed up to a location that is not on the SLB branch office  
manager.  
Restore Factory Defaults: Restores factory defaults. If you  
select this option, the SLB device reboots after you apply the  
update. Select the Save SSH Keys checkbox to save any  
imported or exported SSH keys. Select the Save SSL  
Certificate checkbox to save any imported certificate. Disabled  
by default.  
Restore Saved Configuration: Returns the SLB settings to a  
previously saved configuration. If you select this option, the SLB  
branch office manager reboots after you apply the update.  
Configuration Name  
to Save to or  
If you selected to save or restore a configuration, enter a name  
for the configuration file (up to 12 characters).  
Restore From  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
Location for Save,  
Restore, or Manage  
If you selected to save or restore a configuration, select one of  
the following options:  
Default – Saved Configurations: If restoring, select a saved  
configuration from the drop-down list.  
FTP Server: The FTP server specified in the FTP/SFTP/TFTP  
section. If you select this option, select FTP or SFTP to transfer  
the configuration file.  
NFS Mounted Directory: Local directory of the NFS server for  
mounting files.  
CIFS Share – Saved Configurations: If restoring, select a  
saved configuration from the drop-down list.  
PC Card: If a PC Card Compact Flash is loaded into one of the  
PC Card slots on the front of the SLB branch office manager,  
and properly mounted, the configuration can be saved to or  
restored from this location.  
If you select this option, select the slot (upper or lower) in which  
the PC Card Compact Flash is mounted, and then select a  
saved configuration from the drop-down list.  
Manage: The Manage option allows you to view and delete all  
configurations saved to the selected location. This feature is  
available for the default, CIFS Share, and PC Card locations.  
(See page 183.)  
Preserve  
Configuration after  
Restore  
Allows the user to keep a subset of the current configuration  
after restoring a configuration or resetting to factory defaults.  
Select the checkbox for each part of the current configuration  
you want to keep, for example, Networking, Services, or Device  
Ports.  
3. Click Apply.  
Note: If you selected an option that forces a reboot (restore configuration, update  
firmware, or reset factory defaults), the SLB branch office manager automatically  
reboots at the end of the process.  
To manage configuration files:  
The Manage option on the Firmware & Configurations page allows you to view  
all configurations saved to the selected location and delete any of the  
configurations. This feature is available for the default, CIFS Share, and PC Card  
locations.  
1. On the Firmware and Configurations page, click the Manage link. The following  
page displays the name and the time and date the file was saved:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
2. To delete files, select one or more files and click the Delete button.  
Firmware & Configurations – Web Sessions  
The Firmware & Configurations - Web Sessions page enables you to view and terminate  
current web sessions.  
To view or terminate current web sessions:  
1. On the Firmware & Configurations page, click the Web Sessions link. The  
following page displays:  
Firmware & Configurations – SSL Certificate  
The Firmware & Configurations – SSL Certificate page enables you to view and update  
SSL certificate information. The SSL certificate, consisting of a public/private key pair  
used to encrypt HTTP data, is associated with the web server. You can import a site-  
specific SSL certificate, if desired.  
To view, reset, import, or change an SSL Certificate:  
1. On the Firmware & Configurations page, click the SSL Certificate link. The  
following page displays the current SSL certificate.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
12: Maintenance and Operation  
2. If desired, enter the following:  
Reset to Default  
Certificate  
To reset to the default certificate, select the checkbox to reset to  
the default certificate. Unselected by default.  
Import SSL  
Certificate  
To import your own SSL Certificate, select the checkbox.  
Unselected by default.  
Import via  
From the drop-down list, select the method of importing the  
certificate (SCP or SFTP). The default is SCP.  
Certificate Filename  
Key Filename  
Host  
Filename of the certificate.  
Filename of the private key for the certificate.  
Host name or IPaddress of the host from which to import the file.  
Path of the directory where the certificate will be stored.  
User ID to use to SCP or SFTP the file.  
Path  
Login  
Password & Retype  
Password  
Password to use to SCP or SFTP the file.  
3. Click the Apply button.  
Note: You must reboot the SLB device for the update to take effect.  
4. To return to the Back to Firmware & Configurations page, click the link at the  
bottom of the page.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
iGoogle Gadgets  
You can create an iGoogle gadgets that enables you to view the status of the ports of  
many SLB branch office managers on one web page.  
Anyone with a Google email account (gmail.com) can create an iGoogle gadget for  
viewing web pages. There are two types of iGoogle gadgets: public gadgets and private  
gadgets. The public gadgets are listed for import on iGoogle web pages. The SLB gadget  
is a private gadget, whose location is not publicly advertised.  
To set up an SLB iGoogle gadget:  
1. Load the following XML code on a web server that is accessible over the Internet.  
This code describes how to retrieve information and how to format the data for  
display.  
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?>  
- <Module>  
<ModulePrefs title="__UP_model__ Devport Status"  
title_url="http://www.lantronix.com"  
directory_title="SLC/SLB Status" description="Devport  
status and counters" scrolling="true" width="400"  
height="360" />  
- <UserPref name="model" display_name="Model" datatype="enum"  
default_value="slc">  
<EnumValue value="SLC" display_value="SLC" />  
<EnumValue value="SLB" display_value="SLB" />  
</UserPref>  
<UserPref name="ip" display_name="IP Address" required="true"  
/>  
- <UserPref name="rate" display_name="Refresh Rate"  
datatype="enum" default_value="10">  
<EnumValue value="1" display_value="1 second" />  
<EnumValue value="5" display_value="5 seconds" />  
<EnumValue value="10" display_value="10 seconds" />  
<EnumValue value="30" display_value="30 seconds" />  
<EnumValue value="60" display_value="1 minute" />  
<EnumValue value="300" display_value="5 minutes" />  
<EnumValue value="600" display_value="10 minutes" />  
</UserPref>  
<Content type="url" href="http://__UP_ip__/devstatus.htm" />  
</Module>  
2. On the iGoogle web page, click the Add stuff link.  
3. On the new page, click the Add feed or gadget link.  
4. In the field that displays, type the URL of the gadget location.  
5. Return to the gadget viewing page and complete the SLB gadget configuration  
fields.  
You should see an iGoogle gadget similar to the following:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
Administrative Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
To copy the boot bank from the currently booted bank to the alternate bank (for  
dual-boot SLB branch office managers):  
admin firmware copybank  
To reboot the SLB device:  
admin reboot  
Note: The front panel LCD displays the “Rebooting the SLB” message, and the normal boot  
sequence occurs.  
To add welcome, login, and logout banners:  
admin banner login <Banner Text>  
admin banner logout <Banner Text)  
admin banner welcome <Banner Text>  
Note: To go to the next line, type \n and press Enter.  
To display banners:  
admin banner show  
To prepare the SLB branch office manager to be powered off:  
admin shutdown  
Note: When you use this command to shut down the SLB device, the LCD front panel displays  
"Shutting down the SLB," followed by a pause, and then "Shutdown complete." When "Shutdown  
complete" displays, it is safe to power off the SLB branch office manager. This command is not  
available on the Web page.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
To enable or disable iGoogle Gadget web content:  
admin web gadget <enable|disable>  
To configure the timeout for web sessions:  
admin web timeout <disable|5-120>  
Timeouts are measured in minutes.  
To terminate a web session:  
admin web terminate <web session id>  
To view current timeout and all active web sessions:  
admin web show  
To list current hardware and firmware information:  
admin version  
To update SLB firmware to a new revision:  
Note: The firmware file should be accessible via the settings displayed by admin ftp show.  
The SLB branch office manager automatically reboots after successful update.  
admin firmware update <ftp|tftp|sftp> file <Firmware File> key  
<Checksum Key>  
To set the boot bank to be used at the next SLB reboot:  
admin firmware bootbank <1|2>  
Applies to dual-boot SLB devices only.  
To list the current firmware revision:  
admin firmware show [viewlog <enable|disable>]  
Lists the current firmware revision, the boot bank status (for dual-boot SLB branch office  
managers), and optionally displays the log containing details about firmware updates.  
To lock or unlock the LCD keypad:  
Note: If the keypad is locked, users can scroll through settings but not change them.  
admin keypad <lock|unlock>  
To change the Restore Factory Defaults password used at the LCD to return the SLB  
branch office manager to the factory settings:  
admin keypad password <Password>  
Must be 6 digits.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
To view keypad settings:  
admin keypad show  
To set the FTP/TFTP/SFTP server used for firmware updates and configuration  
save/restore:  
admin ftp server <IP Address or Hostname> [login <User Login>]  
[path <Directory>]  
To view FTP settings:  
admin ftp show  
To set the FTP server password and prevent it from being echoed:  
admin ftp password  
To restore the SLB device to factory default settings:  
admin config factorydefaults [savesshkeys <enable|disable>]  
[savesSLBert <enable|disable>][preserveconfig <Config Params to  
Preserve>]  
<Config Params to Preserve> is a comma-separated list of current configuration  
parameters to retain after the config restore or factorydefaults:  
nt – Networking  
sv – Services  
dt - Date/Time  
lu - Local Users  
dp - Device Ports  
pc – PC Card  
po – Power Outlets  
To restore a saved configuration to the SLB branch office manager:  
admin config restore <Config Name> location  
<default|ftp|sftp|nfs|cifs|pccard> [nfsdir <NFS Mounted Dir>]  
[pccardslot <upper|lower>] [keepconfig <Config Params to Keep>]  
[preserveconfig <Config Params to Prserve>]  
<Config Params to Preserve> is a comma-separated list of current configuration  
parameters to retain after the config restore or factorydefaults:  
nt – Networking  
sv – Services  
dt - Date/Time  
po - Power Outlets  
lu - Local Users  
dp - Device Ports  
pc - PC Card  
To save the current SLB configuration to a selected location:  
admin config save <Config Name> location  
<default|ftp|sftp|nfs|cifs|pccard> [nfsdir <NFS Mounted Dir>]  
[pccardslot <upper|lower>]  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
To delete a saved configuration:  
admin config delete <Config Name> location <default|cifs|pccard>  
[pccardslot <upper|lower>]  
To list the configurations saved to a location:  
admin config show <default|ftp|sftp|nfs|cifs|pccard> [nfsdir <NFS  
Mounted Dir>] [pccardslot <upper|lower>]  
To run the quick setup script:  
admin quicksetup  
To import an SSL certificate, or reset the web server certificate to the default:  
admin web certificate import via <sftp|scp> certfile <Certificate File>  
privfile <Private Key File> host <IP Address or Name>  
login <User Login> [path <Path to Files>]  
To reset a web certificate:  
admin web certificate reset  
To show a web certificate:  
admin web certificate show  
To restart the program that controls the LCD:  
admin lcd reset  
System Logs  
The System Logs page allows you to view various system logs. (See 7: Services for more  
information about system logs.) You can also clear logs on this page.  
To view system logs:  
1. Click the Maintenance tab and select the System Logs option. The following  
page displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
2. Enter the following:  
Log  
Select the type(s) of log you want to view.  
Level  
Select the alert level you want to view for the selected log.  
Starting at  
Select the starting point of the range you want to view:  
Beginning of Log: Beginning of the log.  
Date: Specific start date and time of the log.  
Ending at  
Select the endpoint of the range you want to view:  
End of Log: The end of the log.  
Date: Specific end date and time of the log.  
3. Click the View Log button. The log displays. For example, if you select the type All  
and the level Error, the SLB device displays a log similar to this:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
4. To email the system log to an individual:  
a) In the Comment field, enter a comment (if desired).  
b) Select to and enter the person’s email address.  
c) Press the Email Output button.  
5. To email the system log to Lantronix Technical Support:  
a) In the Comment field, enter a comment (if desired).  
b) Select to: Lantronix Tech Support.  
c) Call Lantronix Tech Support and obtain a case number.  
Note: For contact information, click the Lantronix Tech Support link.  
d) Enter the number in Case Number.  
e) Press the Email Output button.  
6. A message asks for confirmation. Click OK.  
To clear system logs:  
1. From the main menu, select SLB Maintenance – System Logs.  
2. Select the logs you want to clear and click the Clear Log button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
System Log Command  
The following command for the command line interface corresponds to the web page  
entries described above.  
To view the system logs containing information and error messages:  
show syslog [<parameters>]  
Parameters:  
[email <Email Address>]  
level <error|warning|info|debug>  
log <all|netlog|servlog|authlog|devlog|diaglog|genlog>  
display <head|tail> [numlines <Number of Lines>]  
startingtime <MMDDYYhhmm [ss]  
endtime <MMDDYYhhmm [ss]  
Note: The level and time parameters cannot be used simultaneously.  
To clear one or all of the system logs:  
show syslog clear  
<all|netlog|servlog|authlog|devlog|diaglog|genlog>  
Audit Log  
The Audit Log web page displays a log of all actions that have changed the configuration  
of the SLB branch office manager. The audit log is disabled by default. Use the Services  
web page (7: Services) to enable the audit log and to configure its maximum size.  
Each entry in the log file contains a date/time stamp, user login, and the action performed  
by the user. The user may clear the log file and sort the log by date/time, user, and  
command. The audit log is saved through SLB reboots.  
1. Click the Maintenance tab and select the Audit Log option. The following page  
displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
12: Maintenance and Operation  
2. To select a sort option (by Date/Time, User, Command/Action, click the appropriate  
button:  
To sort by date and time, click the Sort by Date/Time button. (This is the  
default.)  
To sort by user, click the Sort by User button.  
To sort by command/action, click the Command button.  
3. To clear the log, click the Clear Log button.  
Diagnostics  
The Diagnostics web page provides methods for diagnosing problems such as network  
connectivity and device port input/output problems. You can use equivalent commands  
on the command line interface. An additional diagnostic, loopback, is only available as a  
command.  
1. Click the Maintenance tab and select the Diagnostics option. The following page  
displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
2. Enter the following:  
Select Diagnostics  
Select one or more diagnostic methods you want to run, or select  
All to run them all.  
ARP Table  
Netstat  
Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) table used to view the IP  
address-to-hardware address mapping.  
Displays network connections. If you select the checkbox, select  
a protocol or select All for both protocols to control the output of  
the Netstat report.  
Host Lookup  
Ping  
If you enter a host name in the corresponding Hostname field,  
verifies that the SLB branch office manager can resolve the host  
name into an IP address (if DNS is enabled).  
If you enter a host name in the corresponding Hostname field,  
verifies that the host is up and running.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
Send Packet  
This option sends an Ethernet packet out one of the Ethernet  
ports, mainly as a network connectivity test.  
Enter the following:  
Protocol: Select the type of packet to send.  
Hostname: Specify a host name or IPaddress of the host to  
send the packet to.  
Port: Specify a TCP or UDP port number of the host to send the  
packet to.  
String: Enter a set of up to 64 characters. The string is  
encapsulated in the packet (so you could use a network sniffer to  
track the packet and, by looking at its contents, verify that it was  
sent).  
Count: The count is the number of times the string is sent.  
For UDP, the number of times the string is sent is equal to the  
number of packets sent.  
For TCP, the number of times the string is sent may (or may not)  
be equal to the number of packets sent, because TCP controls  
how data is packetized and sent out.  
3. Click the Run Diagnostics button. The Diagnostics report page displays.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
4. To view a report, click the link for that report.  
5. To email the report(s) to an individual:  
a) In the Comment field, enter a comment (if desired).  
b) Select to and enter the person’s email address.  
c) Press the Email Output button.  
6. To email the report(s) to Lantronix Technical Support:  
a) In the Comment field, enter a comment (if desired).  
b) Select to: Lantronix Tech Support  
c) Call Lantronix Tech Support and obtain a case number.  
Note: For contact information, click the Lantronix Tech Support link.  
d) Enter the number in Case Number.  
e) Press the Email Output button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
Diagnostic Commands  
The following CLI commands correspond to the web page entries described above.  
To display the ARP table of IP address-to-hardware address mapping:  
diag arp [email <Email Address>]  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
To display a report of network connections:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
diag netstat [protocol <all|tcp|udp>] [email <Email Address>]  
To resolve a host name into an IP address:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
diag lookup <Hostname> [email <Email Address>]  
To test a device port by transmitting data out the port and verifying that it is  
received correctly:  
diag loopback <Device Port Number or Name>[<parameters>]  
Parameters:  
test <internal|external>  
xferdatasize <Size In Kbytes to Transfer>  
Default is 1 Kbyte.  
Note: A special loopback cable comes with the SLB branch office manager. To test a device port,  
plug the cable into the device port and run this command. The command sends the specified  
Kbytes to the device port and reports success or failure. The test is performed at 9600 baud. Only  
an external test requires a loopback cable.  
To display the route that packets take to get to a network host:  
diag traceroute <IP Address or Hostname>  
To verify that the host is up and running:  
diag ping <IP Address or Name> [<parameters>]  
Parameters:  
count <Number of Times to Ping>  
The default is 5.  
packetsize <Size in Bytes>  
The default is 64.  
To display performance statistics for an Ethernet port or a device port (averaged  
over the last 5 seconds):  
diag perfstat[ethport <1|2>] [deviceport <Device Port # or Name>]  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
To generate and send Ethernet packets:  
diag sendpacket host <IP Address or Name> port <TCP or UDP Port  
Number> [string <Packet String>] [protocol <tcp|udp>] [count  
<Number of Packets>]  
The default is 1.  
To display all network traffic, applying optional filters:  
Note: This command is not available  
diag nettrace <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
ethport <1|2>  
host <IP Address or Name>  
numpackets <Number of Packets>  
protocol <tcp|udp|icmp>  
verbose <enable|disable>  
To display information on the internal memory, storage and processes of the SLB  
branch office manager:  
diag internals  
Note: This command is available in the CLI but not the web.  
Status/Reports  
On this page, you can view the status of the SLB ports and power supplies and generate  
a selection of reports.  
Note: Status and statistics shown on the web interface represent a snapshot in time. To  
see the most recent data, you must reload the web page.  
1. Click the Maintenance tab and select the Status/Reports option. The following  
page displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
The top half of the page displays the status of each port, power supply, and power  
outlet. Green indicates that the port connection or power supply is active and  
functioning correctly. Red indicates an error or failure or that the device is off.  
2. Enter the following:  
View Report  
View Report  
Select as many of the reports as desired, or select All.  
Port Status: Displays the status of each device port: mode,  
user, any related connections, and serial port settings.  
Port Counters: Displays statistics related to the flow of data  
through each device port.  
IP Routes: Displays the routing table.  
Connections: Displays all active connections for the SLB branch  
office manager: Telnet, SSH, TCP, UDP, device port, and  
modem.  
System Configuration – Complete: Displays a complete  
snapshot of the SLB settings.  
System Configuration – Basic: Displays a snapshot of the  
SLB device's basic settings (for example, network, date/time,  
routing, services, console port).  
System Configuration – Authentication: Displays a snapshot  
of authentication settings only (including a list of all localusers).  
System Configuration - Devices: Displays a snapshot of  
settings for each device port and (each PC Card slot) for a  
PC Card.  
3. Click the Generate Report button. In the upper left, the report page displays a list  
of reports generated.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
4. To view a report, click the link for that report.  
5. To email the report(s) to Lantronix Technical Support:  
a) In the Comment field, enter a comment (if desired).  
b) Select to: Lantronix Tech Support  
c) Call Lantronix Tech Support and obtain a case number.  
Note: For contact information, click the Lantronix Tech Support link.  
d) Enter the number in Case Number.  
e) Press the Email Output button.  
6. To email the report(s) to an individual:  
a) In the Comment field, enter a comment (if desired).  
b) Select to: and enter the person’s email address.  
c) Press the Email Output button.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
Status Commands  
These commands for the command line interface correspond to the web page entries  
described above.  
To display device port modes and states for one or more ports:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show portstatus [deviceport <Device Port List or Name>] [email  
<Email Address>]  
To display a snapshot of configurable parameters:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show sysconfig [display <basic|auth|devices>] [email <Email  
Address]  
Displays a report of all configurable parameters or a shorter report with  
basic system settings, authentication settings, or device settings.  
To generate a report for one or more ports:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show portcounters [deviceport <Device Port List or Name>] [email  
<Email Address>]  
To display the overall status of all SLB devices:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show sysstatus [email <Email Address>]  
To display a list of all current connections:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show connections [email <Email Address>]  
To provide details, e.g., endpoint parameters and trigger, for a specific connection:  
You can optionally email the displayed information.  
show connections connid <Connection ID> [email <Email Address>]  
Note: Use the basic show connectionscommand to obtain the Connection ID.  
Events  
On this page, you can define what action you want to take for events that may occur in  
the SLB branch office manager.  
1. Click the Maintenance tab and select the Events option. The following page  
displays:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
12: Maintenance and Operation  
2. Enter the following:  
Event Trigger  
From the drop-down list, select the type of incident that triggers an  
event. Currently, the options are:  
Receive Trap  
Temperature Over/Under Limit: For Sensorsoft devices.  
Humidity Over/Under Limit: For Sensorsoft devices.  
Action  
From the drop-down list, select the action taken because of the  
trigger. For example, the action can be writing an entry into the  
syslog with details of the event or sending the trap(s) to the  
Ethernet or modem connection.  
Ethernet  
For actions that require an Ethernet connection (for example,  
Forward All Traps to Ethernet), select the Ethernet port to use.  
Modem  
Connection on  
For actions that require a modem connection (for example,  
Forward All Traps to a Modem Connection, select which device  
port or PC Card slot with a modem connection to use.  
NMS/Host to  
forward trap to  
For actions that forward a trap, enter the IP address of the  
computer to forward the trap to. The computer does not have to  
be an SNMP NMS; it just has to be capable of receiving SNMP  
traps.  
SNMP Community  
Forwarded traps are sent with this SNMP community value  
There is no default.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12: Maintenance and Operation  
SNMP Trap OID  
Enter a unique identifier for an SNMP object. (An SNMP object is  
anything that can hold a value and can be read using an SNMP  
"get" action.) The OID consists of a string of numbers separated  
by periods (for example, 1.1.3.2.1). Each number is part of a  
group represented by the number on its left.  
3. You have the following options:  
To add the defined event, click the Add Event button. The event displays in  
the Events table at the bottom of the page.  
To edit an event, select the event from the Events table and click the Edit  
Event button. The Events page displays the event.  
To delete an event, select the event from the Events table and click the  
Delete Event button. A message asks for confirmation. Click OK.  
4. To save, click Apply.  
Events Commands  
To manage the response to events that occur in the SLB branch office manager:  
admin events add <trigger> <response>  
<trigger> is one of:  
|receivetrap|templimit|humidlimit|overcurrent|  
<response> is one of:  
action <syslog>  
action <fwdalltrapseth|fwdseltrapeth> ethport <1|2>  
nms <SNMP NMS> community <SNMP Community> [oid <SNMP  
OID>]  
action <fwdalltrapsmodem|fwdseltrapmodem> deviceport  
<Device Port # or Name> nms <SNMP NMS> community  
<SNMP Community> [oid <SNMP Trap OID>]  
action <fwdalltrapsmodem|fwdseltrapmodem> pccardslot  
<upper|lower> nms <SNMP NMS> community <SNMP  
Community> [oid <SNMP Trap OID>]  
action <emailalert> emailaddress <destination email  
address>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12: Maintenance and Operation  
To update event definitions:  
admin events edit <Event ID> <parameters>  
Parameters:  
community <SNMP Community>  
deviceport <Device Port # or Name>  
ethport <1|2>  
nms <SNMP NMS>  
oid <SNMP Trap OID>  
pccardslot <upper|lower>  
To delete an event:  
admin events delete <Event ID>  
To view events:  
admin events show  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13: Application Examples  
Each SLB branch office manager has multiple serial ports and two network ports. Each  
serial port can be connected to the console port of an IT device. Using a network port  
(in-band) or a modem (out-of-band) for dial-up connection, an administrator can remotely  
access any of the connected IT devices using Telnet or SSH.  
Figure 13-1. SLB Branch Office Manager Configuration  
This chapter includes three typical scenarios for using the SLB branch office manager.  
The scenarios assume that the SLB device is connected to the network and has already  
been assigned an IP address. In the examples, we use the command line interface. You  
can do the same things using the web page interface except for directly interacting with  
the SLB branch office manager (directcommand).  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
13: Application Examples  
Telnet/SSH to a Remote Device  
The following figure shows a Sun server connected to port 2 of the SLB device.  
Figure 13-2. Remote User Connected to a SUN Server via the SLB Device  
Sun Server  
Remote User  
Serial Cable to Device Port 2  
SLB Branch Office Manager  
Internet  
In this example, the sysadmin would:  
1. Display the current settings for device port 2:  
[SLB]> show deviceport port 2  
___Current Device Port  
Settings________________________________________________  
Number: 2 Name: Port-2  
Modem Settings-------------------Data Settings----------IP Settings---------  
Modem State: disabled  
Modem Mode: text  
Timeout Logins: disabled  
Local IP: negotiate  
Baud Rate: 9600  
Data Bits: 8  
Stop Bits: 1  
Parity: none  
Telnet: disabled  
Telnet Port: 2002  
SSH: disabled  
SSH Port: 3002  
Remote IP: negotiate  
Authentication: PAP  
Flow Control: xon/xoff IP: <none>  
Logins: disabled  
CHAP Host: <none>  
CHAP Secret: <none>  
Break Sequence: \x1bB  
Check DSR: disabled  
NAT: disabled  
Close DSR: disabled  
Dial-out Login: <none>  
Dial-out Password: <none>  
Dial-out Number: <none>  
Dial-back Number: usernumber  
Initialization Script: <none>  
Logging Settings--------------------------------------------------------------  
-
Local Logging: disabled  
Email Logging: disabled  
Byte Threshold: 100  
PC Card Logging: disabled  
Log to: upper slot  
Max number of files: 10  
Max size of files: 2048  
Email Delay: 60  
Restart Delay: 60  
Email To: <none>  
seconds  
seconds  
Email Subject: Port %d Logging  
Email String: <none>  
NFS File Logging: disabled  
Directory to log to: <none>  
Max number of files: 10  
Max size of files: 2048  
2. Change the baud to 57600 and disable flow control:  
[SLB]> set deviceport port 2 baud 57600 flowcontrol none  
Device Port settings successfully updated.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
13: Application Examples  
3. Connect to the device port:  
[SLB]> connect direct deviceport 2  
4. View messages from the SUN server console:  
Mar 15 09:09:44 tssf280r sendmail[292]: [ID 702911 mail.info] starting daemon  
Mar 15 09:09:44 tssf280r sendmail[293]: [ID 702911 mail.info] starting daemon  
(8.12.2+Sun): queueing@00:15:00  
Mar 15 14:44:40 tssf280r sendmail[275]: [ID 702911 mail.info] starting daemon  
Mar 15 14:44:40 tssf280r sendmail[276]: [ID 702911 mail.info] starting daemon  
(8.12.2+Sun): queueing@00:15:00  
5. Reboot the SUN server:  
reboot  
<shutdown messages from SUN>  
6. Use the escape sequence to escape from direct mode back to the command line  
interface.  
Dial-in (Text Mode) to a Remote Device  
Sun UNIX Server  
Remote User  
Serial Cable to Port 2  
Modem  
t
Phone Line  
Phone  
System  
SLB Branch Office Manager  
Serial Cable  
to Port 1  
This example shows a modem connected to an SLB device port, and a Sun server  
connected to another SLB device port. You can configure the modem for text mode dial-  
in, so a remote user can dial into the modem using a terminal emulation program and  
access the Sun server. (HyperTerminal™, which comes with the Microsoft ® Windows™  
operating system, is an example of a terminal emulation program.)  
In this example, the sysadmin would:  
1. Configure the device port that the modem is connected to for dial-in:  
[SLB]> set deviceport port 1 modemmode text  
Device Port settings successfully updated.  
[SLB]> set deviceport port 1 initscript "AT&F&K3&C1&D2%C0A"  
Device Port settings successfully updated.  
[SLB]> set deviceport port 1 auth pap  
Device Port settings successfully updated.  
[SLB]> set deviceport port 1 localsecret "password"  
Device Port settings successfully updated.  
[SLB]> set deviceport port 1 modemstate dialin  
Device Port settings successfully updated.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
13: Application Examples  
[SLB]>  
2. Configure the device port that is connected to the console port of the Sun UNIX  
server:  
[SLB]> set deviceport port 2 baud 57600 flowcontrol none  
Device Port settings successfully updated.  
3. Dial into the SLB branch office manager via the modem using a terminal emulation  
program on a remote PC. A command line prompt displays.  
4. Log into the SLB device.  
CONNECT 57600  
Welcome to the SLB  
login: sysadmin  
Password:  
Welcome to the SLB Branch Office Manager  
Model Number: SLB48  
For a list of commands, type 'help'.  
[SLB]>  
5. Connect to the SUN Unix server using the direct command.  
[SLB]> connect direct deviceport 2  
SunOS 5.7  
login: frank  
Password:  
Last login: Wed Jul 14 16:07:49 from computer  
Sun Microsystems Inc.  
SunOS 5.7  
Generic October 1998  
SunOS computer 5.7 Generic_123485-05 sun4m sparc SUNW,SPARCstation-20  
$
6. Use the escape sequence to escape from direct mode back to the command line  
interface.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13: Application Examples  
Local Serial Connection to Network Device via Telnet  
This example shows a terminal device connected to an SLB device port, and a Sun  
server connected over the network to the SLB branch office manager. When a  
connection is established between the device port and an outbound Telnet session, users  
can access the Sun server as though they were directly connected to it. (See 10:  
Connections for more information).  
Serial Cable to  
Device Port 2  
Internet  
Sun UNIX Server  
In this example, the sysadmin would:  
1. Display the current settings for device port 2:  
[SLB]> show deviceport port 2  
___Current Device Port  
Settings________________________________________________  
Number: 2 Name: Port-2  
Modem Settings-------------------Data Settings----------IP Settings---------  
Modem State: disabled  
Modem Mode: text  
Timeout Logins: disabled  
Local IP: negotiate  
Baud Rate: 9600  
Data Bits: 8  
Stop Bits: 1  
Parity: none  
Telnet: disabled  
Telnet Port: 2002  
SSH: disabled  
SSH Port: 3002  
Remote IP: negotiate  
Authentication: PAP  
CHAP Host: <none>  
Flow Control: xon/xoff IP: <none>  
Logins: disabled  
Break Sequence: \x1bB  
Check DSR: disabled  
CHAP Secret: <none>  
NAT: disabled  
Close DSR: disabled  
Dial-out Login: <none>  
Dial-out Password: <none>  
Dial-out Number: <none>  
Dial-back Number: usernumber  
Initialization Script: <none>  
Logging Settings--------------------------------------------------------------  
-
Local Logging: disabled  
Email Logging: disabled  
PC Card Logging: disabled  
Log to: upper slot  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
13: Application Examples  
Byte Threshold: 100  
Max number of files: 10  
Max size of files: 2048  
Email Delay: 60  
Restart Delay: 60  
Email To: <none>  
seconds  
seconds  
Email Subject: Port %d Logging  
Email String: <none>  
NFS File Logging: disabled  
Directory to log to: <none>  
Max number of files: 10  
Max size of files: 2048  
2. Change the serial settings to match the serial settings for the vt100 terminal -  
changes baud to 57600 and disables flow control:  
[SLB]> set deviceport port 2 baud 57600 flowcontrol none  
Device Port settings successfully updated.  
3. Create a connection between the vt100 terminal connected to device port 2 and an  
outbound telnet session to the server. (The IP address of the server is  
192.168.1.1):  
[SLB]> connect bidirection 2 telnet 192.168.1.1  
Connection settings successfully updated.  
4. At the VT100 terminal, hit <return> a couple of times. The Telnet prompt from the  
server displays:  
Trying 192.168.1.1...  
Connected to 192.168.1.1.  
Escape character is '^]'.  
Sun OS 8.0  
login:  
At this point, a user can log in and interact with the Sun server at the VT100 terminal as if  
directly connected to the server.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
After an introduction to using commands, this chapter lists and describes all of the  
commands available on the SLB command line interface accessed through Telnet, SSH,  
or a serial connection. The commands are in alphabetical order by category.  
Introduction to Commands  
Following is some information about command syntax, command line help, and tips for  
using commands.  
Command Syntax  
Commands have the following format:  
<action> <category> <parameter(s)>  
where  
<action>is set, show, connect, admin, diag, pccard, or logout.  
<category>is a group of related parameters whose settings you want to configure or  
view. Examples are ntp, deviceport, and network.  
<parameter(s)> is one or more name-value pairs in one of the following formats:  
User must specify one of the values (aa or bb)  
separated by a vertical line ( | ). The values  
are in all lowercase and must be entered  
exactly as shown. Bold indicates a default  
value.  
<parameter name> <aabb>  
<parameter name> <Value>  
User must specify an appropriate value, for  
example, an IP address. The parameter  
values are in mixed case. Square brackets [ ]  
indicate optional parameters.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
14: Command Reference  
Table 14-1. Actions and Category Options  
Category  
Action  
set  
network | ipfilter | routing | datetime | ntp | services |  
nfs | cifs | menu | auth | hostlist | localusers |  
remoteusers | ldap | radius | kerberos | tacacs+ |  
consoleport | deviceport | nis | slcnetwork | command |  
sshkey | password | history | cli | locallog | power  
show  
network | ipfilter | routing | datetime | ntp | services |  
nfs | cifs | menu | auth | hostlist | localusers | nis |  
ldap | radius | kerberos | tacacs+ | consoleport |  
deviceport | locallog | sysstatus | syslog | auditlog |  
portstatus | sysconfig | portcounters | connections |  
slcnetwork | sshkey | history | cli | user | remoteusers |  
power  
connect direct | listen | bidirection | unidirection | terminate  
diag  
ping | loopback | traceroute | arp | lookup | netstat |  
perfstat | sendpacket | nettrace | internals  
pccard  
admin  
storage | modem  
reboot | shutdown | ftp | config | firmware | version |  
banner | keypad | quicksetup | web | events | lcd  
logout  
Terminates CLI session.  
Command Line Help  
For general Help and to display the commands to which you have rights, type:  
help  
For general command line Help, type:  
help command line  
For more information about a specific command, type helpfollowed by the command,  
for example:  
help set networkor help admin firmware  
Tips  
Type enough characters to identify the action, category, or parameter name uniquely.  
For parameter values, type the entire value. For example, you can shorten:  
set network port 1 state static ipaddr 122.3.10.1 mask  
255.255.0.0  
to  
se net po 1 st static ip 122.3.10.1 ma 255.255.0.0  
Use the Tab key to automatically complete action, category, or parameter names.  
Type a partial name and press Tab either to complete the name if only one is  
possible, or to display the possible names if more than one is possible. Following a  
space after the preceding name, Tab displays all possible names.  
Should you make a mistake while typing, backspace by pressing the Backspace key  
and/or the Delete key, depending on how you accessed the interface. Both keys  
work if you use VT100 emulation in your terminal access program when connecting  
to the console port. Use the left and right arrow keys to move within a command.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
14: Command Reference  
Use the up and down arrows to scroll through previously entered commands. If  
desired, select one and edit it. You can scroll through up to 100 previous commands  
entered in the session.  
To clear an IP address, type 0.0.0.0,or to clear a non-IP address value, type  
CLEAR.  
When the number of lines displayed by a command exceeds the size of the window  
(the default is 25), the command output is halted until the user is ready to continue.  
To display the next line, press Enter, and to display the page, press the space bar.  
You can override the number of lines (or disable the feature altogether) with the set  
cli command.  
Administrative Commands  
admin banner login  
Syntax  
admin banner login <Banner Text>  
Description  
Configures the banner displayed after the user logs in.  
Note: To go to the next line, type \n and press Enter.  
admin banner logout  
Syntax  
admin banner logout <Banner Text>  
Description  
Configures the banner displayed after the user logs out.  
Note: To go to the next line, type \n and press Enter.  
admin banner show  
Syntax  
admin banner show  
Description  
Displays the welcome, login, and logout banners.  
admin banner welcome  
Syntax  
admin banner welcome <Banner Text>  
Description  
Configures the banner displayed before the user logs in.  
Note: To go to the next line, type \n and press Enter.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
admin config delete  
Syntax  
admin config delete <Config Name> location <default|cifs|pccard>  
[pccardslot <upper|lower>]  
Description  
Deletes a configuration.  
admin config factorydefaults  
Syntax  
admin config factorydefaults [savesshkeys <enable|disable>]  
[savesSLBert <enable|disable>][preserveconfig <Config Params to  
Preserve>]  
<Config Params to Preserve> is a comma-separated list of current configuration  
parameters to retain after the config restore or factorydefaults:  
nt – Networking  
sv – Services  
dt - Date/Time  
po - Power Outlets  
lu - Local Users  
dp - Device Ports  
pc - PC Card  
Description  
Restores the SLB branch office manager to factory default settings.  
admin config restore  
Syntax  
admin config restore <Config Name> location  
<default|ftp|sftp|nfs|cifs|pccard> [nfsdir <NFS Mounted Dir>]  
[pccardslot <upper|lower>] [preserveconfig <Config Params to Preserve>]  
<Config Params to Preserve> is a comma-separated list of current configuration  
parameters to retain after the config restore or factorydefaults:  
nt – Networking  
sv – Services  
dt - Date/Time  
po - Power Outlets  
lu - Local Users  
dp - Device Ports  
pc - PC Card  
Description  
Restores a saved configuration to the SLB device.  
admin config save  
Syntax  
admin config save <Config Name> location  
<default|ftp|sftp|nfs|cifs|pccard> [nfsdir <NFS Mounted Dir>]  
[pccardslot <upper|lower>]  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Saves the current SLB configuration to a selected location.  
admin config show  
Syntax  
admin config show <default|ftp|sftp|nfs|cifs|pccard> [nfsdir <NFS  
Mounted Dir>] [pccardslot <upper|lower>]  
Description  
Lists the configurations saved to a location.  
admin firmware bootbank  
Syntax  
admin firmware bootbank <1|2>  
Description  
Sets the boot bank to be used at the next SLB reboot. Applies to dual-boot SLB branch office  
managers only.  
admin firmware copybank  
Syntax  
admin firmware copybank  
Description  
Copies the boot bank from the currently booted bank to the alternate bank (for dual-boot SLB  
devices).  
admin firmware show  
Syntax  
admin firmware show [viewlog <enable|disable>]  
Description  
Lists the current firmware revision, the boot bank status (for dual-boot SLB branch office  
managers), and optionally displays the log containing details about firmware updates.  
admin firmware update  
Syntax  
admin firmware update <ftp|tftp|sftp|> file <Firmware File> key  
<Checksum Key>  
Description  
Updates SLB firmware to a new revision.  
You should be able to access the firmware file using the settings admin ftp show displays.  
The SLB branch office manager automatically reboots after successful update.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
admin ftp password  
Syntax  
admin ftp password  
Description  
Sets the FTP server password and prevent it from being echoed.  
admin ftp server  
Syntax  
admin ftp server <IP Address or Hostname> [login <User Login>] [path  
<Directory>]  
Description  
Sets the FTP/TFTP/SFTP server used for firmware updates and configuration save/restore.  
admin ftp show  
Syntax  
admin ftp show  
Description  
Displays FTP settings.  
admin keypad  
Syntax  
admin keypad <lock|unlock>  
Description  
Locks or unlocks the LCD keypad.  
If the keypad is locked, you can scroll through settings but not change them.  
admin keypad password  
Syntax  
admin keypad password <Password>  
Must be 6 digits.  
Description  
Changes the Restore Factory Defaults password used at the LCD to return the SLB device to the  
factory settings.  
admin keypad show  
Syntax  
admin keypad show  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Displays keypad settings.  
admin lcd reset  
Syntax  
admin lcd reset  
Description  
Restarts the program that controls the LCD.  
admin quicksetup  
Syntax  
admin quicksetup  
Description  
Runs the quick setup script.  
admin reboot  
Syntax  
admin reboot  
Description  
Reboots the SLB branch office manager.  
The front panel LCD displays the “Rebooting the SLB” message, and the normal boot sequence  
occurs.  
admin shutdown  
Syntax  
admin shutdown  
Description  
Prepares the SLB branch office manager to be powered off.  
When you use this command to shut down the SLB device, the LCD front panel displays the  
“Shutting down the SLB” message, followed by a pause, and then “Shutdown complete.” When  
“Shutdown complete” displays, it is safe to power off the SLB branch office manager. This  
command is not available on the Web page.  
admin version  
Syntax  
admin version  
Description  
Displays current hardware and firmware information.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
admin web certificate  
Syntax  
admin web certificate import via <sftp|scp> certfile <Certificate File>  
privfile <Private Key File> host <IP Address or Name>  
login <User Login> [path <Path to Files>]  
Description  
Imports an SSL certificate.  
admin web certificate reset  
Syntax  
admin web certificate reset  
Description  
Resets a web certificate.  
admin web certificate show  
Syntax  
admin web certificate show  
Description  
Displays a web certificate.  
admin web gadget  
Syntax  
admin web gadget <enable|disable>  
Description  
Enables or disables iGoogle Gadget web content.  
admin web timeout  
Syntax  
admin web timeout <disable|5-120>  
Description  
Configures the timeout for web sessions.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
admin web terminate  
Syntax  
admin web terminate <Session ID>  
Description  
Terminates a web session.  
admin web show  
Syntax  
admin web show  
Description  
Displays the current sessions and their ID.  
Add ‘admin web certificate’ commands  
Audit Log Commands  
show auditlog  
Syntax  
show auditlog [command|user|clear]  
Description  
Displays audit log. By default, shows the audit log sorted by date/time. You can sort it by user or  
command, or clear the audit log.  
Authentication Commands  
set auth  
Syntax  
set auth <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
authusenextmethod <enable|disable>  
kerberos <1-6>  
ldap <1-6>  
localusers <1-6>  
nis <1-6>  
radius <1-6>  
tacacs+ <1-6>  
Description  
Sets ordering of authentication methods.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
14: Command Reference  
Local Users authentication is always the first method used. Any methods omitted from the  
command are disabled.  
show auth  
Syntax  
show auth  
Description  
Displays authentication methods and their order of precedence.  
show user  
Syntax  
show user  
Description  
Displays attributes of the currently logged in user.  
Kerberos Commands  
set kerberos  
Syntax  
set kerberos <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
clearports <Port List>  
custommenu <Menu Name>  
dataports <Port List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
group <default|power|admin>  
ipaddr <Key Distribution Center IP Address>  
kdc <Key Distribution Center>  
listenports <Port List>  
permissions <Permission List>  
Note: See User Permissions Commands on page 228 for information on groups and user rights.  
port <Key Distribution Center TCP Port>  
realm <Kerberos Realm>  
state <enable|disable>  
useldapforlookup <enable|disable>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Configures the SLB branch office manager to use Kerberos to authenticate users who log in via  
the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port.  
show kerberos  
Syntax  
show kerberos  
Description  
Displays Kerberos settings.  
LDAP Commands  
set ldap  
Syntax  
set ldap <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
adsupport <enable|disable>  
base <LDAP Base>  
bindname <Bind Name>  
bindpassword <Bind Password>  
clearports <Port List>  
custommenu <Menu Name>  
dataports <Port List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
encrypt <enable|disable>  
group <default|power|admin>  
listenports <Port List>  
permissions <Permission List>  
port <TCP Port>  
server <IP Address or Hostname>  
state <enable|disable>  
Default is 389.  
Note: See User Permissions Commands on page 228 for information on groups and user rights.  
Description  
Configures the SLB device to use LDAP to authenticate users who log in via the Web, SSH,  
Telnet, or the console port.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
show ldap  
Description  
Displays LDAP settings:  
Syntax  
show ldap  
Local Users Commands  
set localusers add|edit  
Syntax  
set localusers add|edit <User Login> <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
allowdialback <enable|disable>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
changenextlogin <enable|disable>  
changepassword <enable|disable>  
clearports <Port List>  
dataports <Port List>  
dialbacknumber <Phone Number>  
displaymenu <enable|disable>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
listenports <Port List>  
custommenu <Menu Name>  
uid <User Identifier>  
group <default|power|admin>  
passwordexpires <enable|disable>  
permissions <Permission List>  
Note: See User Permissions Commands on page 228 for information on groups and user rights.  
Description  
Configures local accounts (including sysadmin) who log in to the SLB branch office manager by  
means of the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
set localusers allowreuse  
Syntax  
set localusers allowreuse <enable|disable>  
Description  
Sets whether a login password can be reused.  
set local users complexpasswords  
Syntax  
set localusers complexpasswords <enable|disable>  
Description  
Sets whether a complex login password is required.  
set localusers state  
Syntax  
set localusers state <enable|disable>  
Description  
Enables or disables authentication of local users.  
set localusers delete  
Syntax  
set localusers delete <User Login>  
Description  
Deletes a local user.  
set localusers lifetime  
Syntax  
set localusers lifetime <Number of Days>  
Description  
Sets the number of days the login password may be used. The default is 90 days.  
set localusers maxloginattempts  
Syntax  
set localusers maxloginattempts <Number of Logins>  
Description  
Sets the maximum number of login attempts before the account is locked. Disabled by default.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
set localusers password  
Syntax  
set localusers password <User Login>  
Description  
Sets a login password for the local user.  
set localusers periodlockout  
Syntax  
set localusers periodlockout <Number of Minutes>  
Description  
Sets the number of minutes after a lockout before the user can try to log in again. Disabled by  
default.  
set localusers periodwarning  
Syntax  
set localusers periodwarning <Number of Days>  
Description  
Sets the number of days the system warns the user that the password will be expiring. The  
default is 7 days.  
set localusers reusehistory  
Syntax  
set localusers reusehistory <Number of Passwords>  
Description  
Sets the number of passwords the user must use before reusing an old password. The default is 4.  
set localusers state  
Syntax  
set localusers state <enable|disable>  
Description  
Enables or disables authentication of local users.  
show localusers  
Syntax  
show localusers [user <User Login>]  
Description  
Displays local users.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
NIS Commands  
set nis  
Syntax  
set nis <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
broadcast <enable|disable>  
clearports <Port List>  
custommenu <Menu Name>  
dataports <Port List>  
domain <NIS Domain Name>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
group <default|power|admin>  
listenports <Port List>  
master <IP Address or Hostname>  
permissions <Permission List>  
Note: See User Permissions Commands on page 228 for information on groups and user rights.  
slave1 <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave2 <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave3 <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave4 <IP Address or Hostname>  
slave5 <IP Address or Hostname>  
state <enable|disable>  
Description  
Configures the SLB device to use NIS to authenticate users who log in via the Web, SSH, Telnet,  
or the console port.  
show nis  
Syntax  
show nis  
Description  
Displays NIS settings.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
RADIUS Commands  
set radius  
Syntax  
set radius <one or more parameters>  
Parameters:  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
state <enable|disable>  
clearports <Port List>  
custommenu <Menu Name>  
dataports <Port List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
group <default|power|admin>  
listenports <Port List>  
permissions <Permission List>  
Note: See User Permissions Commands on page 228 for information on groups and user rights.  
timeout <enable|1-30>  
Sets the number of seconds after which the connection attempt times out. It may be 1-30 seconds.  
Description  
Configures the SLB branch office manager to use RADIUS to authenticate users who log in via  
the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port.  
set radius server  
Syntax  
set radius server <1|2> host <IP Address or Hostname> secret <Secret>  
[port <TCP Port>]  
Description  
Identifies the RADIUS server(s), the text secret, and the number of the TCP port on the RADIUS  
server.  
Note: The default port is 1812.  
show radius  
Syntax  
show radius  
Description  
Displays RADIUS settings.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
TACACS+ Commands  
set tacacs+  
Syntax  
set tacacs+ <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
clearports <Port List>  
custommenu <Menu Name>  
dataports <Port List>  
encrypt <enable|disable>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
group <default|power|admin>  
listenports <Port List>  
permissions <Permission List>  
Note: See User Permissions Commands on page 228 for information on groups and user rights.  
secret <TACACS+ Secret>  
server1 <IP Address or Name>  
server2 <IP Address or Name>  
server3 <IP Address or Name>  
state <enable|disable>  
Description  
Configures the SLB branch office manager to use TACACS+ to authenticate users who log in via  
the Web, SSH, Telnet, or the console port.  
show tacacs+  
Syntax  
show tacacs+  
Description  
Displays TACACS+ settings.  
User Permissions Commands  
set localusers group  
Syntax  
set localusers add|edit <user> group <default|power|admin>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Adds a local user to a user group or changes the group the user belongs to.  
set localusers lock  
Syntax  
set local users unlock <User Login>  
Description  
Blocks (locks) a user's ability to login.  
set localusers unlock  
Syntax  
set local users unlock <User Login>  
Description  
Allows (unlocks) a user's ability to login.  
set localusers permissions  
Syntax  
set localusers add|edit <user> permissions <Permission List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp,  
pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad, po  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter abbreviation for a user  
permission.  
Description  
Sets a local user's permissions (not defined by the user group).  
set remoteusers add|edit  
Syntax  
set remoteusers add|edit <User Login> [<parameters>]  
Parameters  
accessoutlets <Outlet List>  
dataports <Port List>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
listenports <Port List>  
clearports <Port List>  
group <default|power|admin>  
permissions <Permissions List>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp, pc, rs,  
rc, dr, wb, sn, ad, po  
To remove a permission, type a minus sign before the two-letter abbreviation for a user right.  
Description  
Sets attributes for users who log in by a remote authentication method.  
set remoteusers listonlyauth  
Syntax  
set remoteusers listonlyauth <enable|disable>  
Description  
Sets whether remote users who are not part of the remote user list will be authenticated.  
set remoteusers delete  
Syntax  
set remoteusers delete <User Login>  
Description  
Removes a remote user.  
show remoteusers  
Syntax  
show remoteusers  
Description  
Displays settings for all remote users  
set <nis|ldap|radius|kerberos|tacacs+> group  
Syntax  
set <nis|ldap|radius|kerberos|tacacs> group <default|power|admin>  
Description  
Sets a permission group for remotely authorized users.  
set <nis|ldap|radius|kerberos|tacacs+> permissions  
Syntax  
set <nis|ldap|radius|kerberos|tacacs> permissions <Permission List>  
where  
<Permission List> is one or more of nt, sv, dt, lu, ra, sk, um, dp,  
pc, rs, rc, dr, wb, sn, ad, po  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Sets permissions not already defined by the assigned permissions group.  
show user  
Syntax  
show user  
Description  
Displays the rights of the currently logged-in user:  
CLI Commands  
set cli  
Syntax  
set cli scscommands <enable|disable>  
Description  
Allows you to use SCS-compatible commands as shortcuts for executing commands. Enabling  
this feature enables it only for the current cli session. It is disabled by default.  
Note: Settings are retained between CLI sessions for local users and users listed in the remote  
users list.  
set cli terminallines  
Syntax  
set cli terminallines <disable|Number of lines>  
Description  
Sets the number of lines in the terminal emulation (screen) for paging through text one screenful  
at a time, if the SLB device cannot detect the size of the terminal automatically.  
Note: Settings are retained between CLI sessions for local users and users listed in the remote  
users list.  
set localusers lock  
Syntax  
set localusers lock <User Login>  
Description  
Block (lock out) a user’s ability to log in.  
set localusers unlock  
Syntax  
set localusers unlock <User Login>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Allow (unlock) a user’s ability to log in.  
show cli  
Syntax  
show cli  
Description  
Displays current CLI settings.  
show user  
Syntax  
show user  
Description  
Displays attributes of the currently logged in user.  
set history  
Syntax  
set history clear  
Description  
Clears the commands that have been entered during the command line interface session.  
show history  
Syntax  
show history  
Description  
Displays the last 100 commands entered during the session.  
Connection Commands  
connect bidirection  
Syntax  
connect bidirection <Port # or Name> <endpoint> <one or more  
Parameters>  
Parameters  
Endpoint is one of:  
charcount <# of Chars>  
charseq <Char Sequence>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
charxfer <toendpoint|fromendpoint>  
date <MMDDYYhhmm[ss]>  
deviceport <Device Port # or Name>  
exclusive <enable|disable>  
ssh <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port>][<SSH flags>]  
where <SSH flags> is one or more of:  
user <Login Name>  
version <1|2>  
command <Command to Execute>  
tcp <IP Address> [port <TCP Port>]  
telnet <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port>]  
trigger <now|datetime|chars>  
If the trigger is datetime(establish connection at a specified date/time), enter the date  
parameter. If the trigger is chars(establish connection on receipt of a specified number  
or characters or a character sequence), enter the charxferparameter and either the  
charcountor the charseq parameter.  
udp <IP Address> [port <UDP Port>]  
Description  
Connects a device port to another device port or an outbound network connection (data  
flows in both directions).  
connect direct  
Syntax  
connect direct <endpoint>  
Parameters  
Endpoint is one of:  
deviceport <Device Port # or Name>  
ssh <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port>][<SSH flags>]  
where <SSH flags> is one or more of:  
user <Login Name>  
version <1|2>  
command <Command to Execute>  
tcp <IP Address> [port <TCP Port>]  
telnet <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port>]  
udp <IP Address> [port <UDP Port>  
Description  
Connects to a device port to monitor and/or interact with it, or establishes an outbound network  
connection.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
connect global outgoingtimeout  
Syntax  
connect global outgoingtimeout <disable|1-9999 seconds>  
Description  
Sets the amount of time the SLB branch office manager will wait for a response (sign of life) from an  
SSH/Telnet server that it is trying to connect to.  
Note: This is not a TCP timeout.  
connect listen deviceport  
Syntax  
connect listen deviceport <Device Port # or Name>  
Description  
Monitors a device port.  
connect terminate  
Syntax  
connect terminate <Connection ID>  
Description  
Terminates a bidirectional or unidirectional connection.  
connect unidirection  
Syntax  
connect unidirection <Device Port # or Name> dataflow  
<toendpointfromendpoint> <endpoint>  
Parameters  
Endpoint is one of:  
charcount <# of Chars>  
charseq <Char Sequence>  
datetime <MMDDYYhhmm[ss]>  
deviceport <Port # or Name>  
exclusive <enable|disable>  
ssh <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port][<SSH flags>]  
where <SSH flags> is one or more of:  
user <Login Name>  
version <1|2>  
command <Command to Execute>  
tcp <IP Address> [port <TCP Port>]  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
telnet <IP Address or Name> [port <TCP Port]  
trigger <now|datetime|chars>  
If the trigger is datetime(establish connection at a specified date/time), enter the date  
parameter. If the trigger is chars(establish connection on receipt of a specified number or  
characters or a character sequence), enter either the charcountor the charseq parameter.  
udp <IP Address> [port <UDP Port>]  
Description  
Connects a device port to another device port or an outbound network connection (data flows in  
one direction).  
show connections  
Syntax  
show connections [email <Email Address>]  
Description  
Displays connections and their IDs. You can optionally email the displayed information.  
The connection IDs are in the left column of the resulting table. The connection ID  
associated with a particular connection may change if the connection times out and is  
restarted.  
show connections connid  
Syntax  
show connections connid <Connection ID> [email <Email Address>]  
Description  
Displays details for a single connection. You can optionally email the displayed information.  
Console Port Commands  
set consoleport  
Syntax  
set consoleport <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
baud <300-115200>  
databits <7|8>  
flowcontrol <none|xon/xoff|rts/cts>  
parity <none|odd|even>  
showlines <enable|disable>  
stopbits <1|2>  
timeout <disable|1-30>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Configures console port settings.  
show consoleport  
Syntax  
show consoleport  
Description  
Displays console port settings.  
Custom User Menu Commands  
When creating a custom user menu, note the following limitations:  
Maximum of 20 custom user menus.  
Maximum of 50 commands per custom user menu (logoutis always the last command).  
Maximum of 15 characters for menu names.  
Maximum of five nested menus can be called.  
No syntax checking. (Enter each command correctly.)  
set localusers  
Syntax  
set localusers add|edit <User Login> menu <Menu Name>  
Description  
Assigns a custom user menu to a local user.  
set menu add  
Syntax  
set menu add <Menu Name> [command <Command Number>]  
Description  
Creates a new custom user menu or adds a command to an existing custom user menu.  
set menu edit  
Syntax  
set menu edit <Menu Name> <parameter>  
Parameters  
command <Command Number>  
nickname <Command Number>  
redisplaymenu <enable|disable>  
shownicknames <enable|disable>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
title <Menu Title>  
Description  
Changes a command within an existing custom user menu.  
Changes a nickname within an existing custom user menu.  
Enables or disables the redisplay of the menu before each prompt.  
Enables or disables the display of command nicknames instead of commands.  
Sets the optional title for a menu.  
set menu delete  
Syntax  
set menu delete <Menu Name> [command <Command Number>]  
Description  
Deletes a custom user menu or one command within a custom user menu.  
set <nis|ldap|radius|kerberos|tacacs+> custommenu  
Syntax  
set <nis|ldap|radius|kerberos|tacacs> custommenu <Menu Name>  
Description  
Sets a default custom menu for remotely authorized users.  
show menu  
Syntax  
show menu <all|Menu Name>  
Description  
Displays a list of all menu names or all commands for a specific menu:  
Date and Time Commands  
set datetime  
Syntax  
set datetime <one date/time parameter>  
Parameters  
date <MMDDYYhhmm[ss]>  
timezone <Time Zone>  
Note: If you type an invalid time zone, the system guides you through the process of  
selecting a time zone.  
Description  
Sets the local date, time, and local time zone (one parameter at a time).  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
show datetime  
Syntax  
show datetime  
Description  
Displays the local date, time, and time zone.  
set ntp  
Syntax  
set ntp <one or more ntp parameters>  
Parameters  
localserver1 <IP Address or Hostname>  
localserver2 <IP Address or Hostname>  
localserver3 <IP Address or Hostname>  
poll <local|public>  
publicserver <IP Address or Hostname>  
state <enable|disable>  
sync <broadcast|poll>  
Description  
Synchronizes the SLB branch office manager with a remote time server using NTP.  
show ntp  
Syntax  
show ntp  
Description  
Displays NTP settings.  
Device Commands  
set command  
Syntax  
set command <Device Port # or Name or List> <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
slp auth login <User Login>  
Establishes the authentication information to log into the SLP power manager attached to the  
device port.  
slp restart  
Issues the CLI command the SLP power manager uses to restart itself.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
slp outletcontrol state <on|off|cyclepower> [outlet <Outlet #>][tower  
<A|B>]  
Outlet # is 1-8 for SLP8 power manager and 1-16 for SLP16 power manager.  
The outletcontrolparameters control individual outlets.  
slp outletstate [outlet <Outlet #>]  
The outletstateparameter shows the state of all outlets or a single outlet.  
slp envmon  
Displays the environmental status (e.g., temperature and humidity) of the SLP power manager.  
slp infeedstatus  
Displays the infeed status and load of the SLP power manager.  
slp system  
Provides system information for the SLP power manager.  
sensorsoft lowtemp <Low Temperature in C.>  
Sets the lowest temperature permitted for the port.  
sensorsoft hightemp <High Temperature in C.>  
Sets the hightest temperature permitted for the port.  
sensorsoft lowhumidity <Low Humidity %>  
Sets the lowest humidity pemitted for the port.  
sensorsoft highhumidity <High Humidity %>  
Sets the lowest humidity permitted for the port.  
sensorsoft traps <enable|disable>  
Enables or disables traps when specified conditions are met.  
sensorsoft status  
Displays the status of the port.  
Description  
Sends commands to (or control) a device connected to an SLB device port over the serial port.  
Note: Currently the only devices supported for this type of interaction are the SLP and Sensorsoft  
devices.  
Device Port Commands  
set deviceport port  
Syntax  
set deviceport port <Device Port List or Name> <one or more device port  
parameters>  
Example: set deviceport port 2-5,6,12,15-16 baud 2400  
Parameters  
auth <pap|chap>  
banner <Banner Text>  
baud <300-115200>  
breakseq <1-10 Chars>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
calleridcmd <Modem Command String>  
calleridlogging <enable| disable>  
chaphost <CHAP Host or User Name>  
chapsecret <CHAP Secret or User Password>  
The user defines the secret.  
checkdsr <enable|disable>  
closedsr <enable|disable>  
databits <7|8>  
device <none|slp8|slp16>  
dialbacknumber <usernumber|Phone Number>  
dialoutlogin <User Login>  
dialoutnumber <Phone Number>  
dialoutpassword <Password>  
dodauth <pap|chap>  
dodchaphost <CHAP Host or User Name>  
dodchapsecret <CHAP Secret or User Password>  
flowcontrol <none|xon/xoff|rts/cts>  
gsmautodns <enable|disable>  
gsmbearerservice <GSM Bearer Service>  
gsmcompression <enable|disable>  
gsmcontext <GPRS Context Id>  
gsmdialoutmode <gprs|gsm>  
gsmpin <GSM/GPRS PIN Number>  
initscript <Initialization Script>  
A script that initializes a modem.  
Note: We recommend preceding the initscript with AT and include E1 V1 x4 Q0 so that the SLB  
branch office manager may properly control the modem.  
ipaddr <IP Address>  
localipaddr <negotiate|IP Address>  
logins <enable|disable>  
modemmode <text|ppp>  
modemstate <disable|dialout|dialin|dialback|dialondemand|  
dialin+dialondemand>  
modemtimeout <disable|1-9999 seconds>  
name <Port Name>  
nat <enable|disable>  
parity <none|odd|even>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
remoteipaddr <negotiate|IP Address>  
restartdelay <PPP Restart Delay>  
slp infeedstatus  
Displays the infeed status and load of the SLP power manager.  
sshauth <enable|disable>  
sshin <enable|disable>  
sshport <TCP Port>  
stopbits <1|2>  
telnetauth <enable|disable>  
telnetin <enable|disable>  
telnetport <TCP Port>  
timeoutlogins <disable or 1-30>  
webcolumns <Web SSH/Telnet Cols>  
webrows <Web SSH/Telnet Rows>  
Description  
Configures a single port or a group of ports.  
set deviceport global  
Syntax  
set deviceport global <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
sshport <TCP Port>  
telnetport <TCP Port>  
tcpport <TCP Port>  
maxdirect <1-10>  
Description  
Configures settings for all or a group of device ports.  
show deviceport global  
Syntax  
show deviceport global  
Description  
Displays global settings for device ports.  
show deviceport names  
Syntax  
show deviceport names  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Displays a list of all device port names.  
show deviceport port  
Syntax  
show deviceport port <Device Port List or Name>  
Description  
Displays the settings for one or more device ports.  
show portcounters  
Syntax  
show portcounters [deviceport <Device Port List or Name>] [email <Email  
Address>]  
Description  
Displays device port statistics and errors for one or more ports. You can optionally email the  
displayed information.  
show portcounters zerocounters  
Syntax  
show portcounters zerocounters <Device Port List or Name>  
Description  
Zeros the port counters for one or more device ports.  
show portstatus  
Syntax  
show portstatus [deviceport <Device Port List or Name>] [email <Email  
Address>]  
Description  
Displays the modes and states of one or more device port(s). You can optionally email the  
displayed information.  
Diagnostic Commands  
diag arp  
Syntax  
diag arp [email <Email Address>]  
Description  
Displays the ARP table of IP address-to-hardware address mapping. You can optionally email the  
displayed information.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
diag internals  
Syntax  
diag internals  
Description  
Displays information on the internal memory, storage and processes of the SLB branch office  
manager.  
Note: This command is available in the CLI but not the web.  
diag netstat  
Syntax  
diag netstat [protocol <all|tcp|udp>] [email <Email Address>]  
Description  
To display a report of network connections. You can optionally email the displayed information.  
diag nettrace  
Syntax  
diag nettrace <one or more parameters>  
Parmeters  
ethport <1|2>  
host <IP Address or Name>  
numpackets <Number of Packets>  
protocol <tcp|udp|icmp>  
verbose <enable|disable>  
Description  
Displays all network traffic, applying optional filters. This command is not available on the web  
page.  
diag lookup  
Syntax  
diag lookup <Hostname> [email <Email Address>]  
Description  
Resolves a host name into an IP address. You can optionally email the displayed information.  
diag loopback  
Syntax  
diag loopback <Device Port Number or Name>[<parameters>]  
Parameters  
test <internal|external>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
xferdatasize <Size In Kbytes to Transfer>  
Default is 1 Kbyte.  
Description  
Tests a device port by transmitting data out the port and verifying that it is received correctly.  
A special loopback cable comes with the SLB branch office manager. To test a device port, plug  
the cable into the device port and run this command. The command sends the specified Kbytes to  
the device port and reports success or failure. The test is performed at 9600 baud. Only an  
external test requires a loopback cable.  
diag traceroute  
Syntax  
diag traceroute <IP Address or Hostname>  
Description  
Displays the route that packets take to get to a network host:  
End Device Commands  
set command  
Syntax  
set command <Device Port # or Name or List> <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
slp auth login <User Login>  
Establishes the authentication information to log into the SLP power manager attached to the  
device port.  
slp envmon  
Displays the environmental status (e.g., temperature and humidity) of the SLP power manager.  
slp outletcontrol state <on|off|cyclepower> [outlet <Outlet #>]  
Outlet # is 1-8 for SLP8 power manager and 1-16 for SLP16 power manager. The  
outletcontrolparameters control individual outlets.  
slp outletstate [outlet <Outlet #>]  
Shows the state of all outlets or a single outlet.  
slp restart  
Issues the CLI command the SLP power manager uses to restart itself.  
slp system  
Displays system information for the SLP power manager.  
Description  
Sends commands to (or controls) a device connected to an SLB device port over the serial port.  
Currently the only type of device supported for this type of interaction is the SLP power manager.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
Events Commands  
admin events add  
Syntax  
admin events add <receivetrap> <response>  
<response> is one of:  
action <fwdalltrapseth|fwdseltrapeth> ethport <1|2> nms <SNMP  
NMS> community <SNMP Community> [oid <SNMP OID>]  
action <fwdalltrapsmodem|fwdseltrapmodem> deviceport <Device Port  
# or Name> nms <SNMP NMS> community <SNMP Community> [oid <SNMP  
Trap OID>]  
action <fwdalltrapsmodem|fwdseltrapmodem> pccardslot  
<upper|lower> nms <SNMP NMS> community <SNMP Community> [oid  
<SNMP Trap OID>]  
action <syslog>  
Description  
Defines events.  
admin events delete  
Syntax  
admin events delete <Event ID>  
Description  
Deletes an event definition.  
admin events edit  
Syntax  
admin events edit <Event ID> <parameters>  
Parameters  
community <SNMP Community>  
deviceport <Device Port # or Name>  
ethport <1|2>  
nms <SNMP NMS>  
oid <SNMP Trap OID>  
pccardslot <upper|lower>  
Description  
Edits event definitions.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
admin events show  
Syntax  
admin events show  
Description  
Displays event definitions.  
Host List Commands  
set hostlist add|edit <Host List Name>  
Syntax  
set hostlist add|edit <Host List Name> [<parameters>]  
Parameters  
name <Host List Name> (edit only)  
retrycount <1-10>  
Default is 3.  
auth <enable|disable>  
Description  
Configures a prioritized list of hosts to be used for modem dial-in connections.  
set hostlist add|edit <Host List Name> entry  
Syntax  
set hostlist add|edit <Host List Name> entry <Host Number>  
[<parameters>]  
Parameters:  
host <IP Address or Name>  
protocol <ssh|telnet|tcp>  
port <TCP Port>  
escapeseq <1-10 Chars>  
Description  
Adds a new host entry to a list or edit an existing entry.  
set hostlist edit <Host List Name> move  
Syntax  
set hostlist edit <Host List Name> move <Host Number> position <Host  
Number>  
Description  
Moves a host entry to a new position in the host list.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
set hostlist delete  
Syntax  
set hostlist delete <Host List> [entry <Host Number>]  
Description  
Deletes a host list, or a single host entry from a host list.  
show hostlist  
Syntax  
show hostlist <all|names|Host List Name>  
Description  
Displays the members of a host list.  
IP Filter Commands  
set ipfilter state  
Syntax  
set ipfilter state  
Description  
Enables or disables IP filtering for incoming network traffic.  
set ipfilter mapping  
Syntax  
set ipfilter mapping <parameters>  
Parameters  
ethernet <1|2> state <disable>  
ethernet <1|2> state <enable> ruleset <Ruleset Name>  
deviceport <1..48> state <disable>  
deviceport <1..48> state <enable> ruleset <Ruleset Name>  
pccardslot <upper|lower> state <disable>  
pccardslot <upper|lower> state <enable> ruleset <Ruleset Name>  
Description  
Maps an IP filter to an interface.  
set ip filter rules  
Syntax  
set ipfilter rules <parameters>  
Parameters  
add <Ruleset Name>  
delete <Ruleset Name>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
edit <Ruleset Name> <Edit Parameters>  
Edit Parameters:  
append  
insert <Rule Number>  
replace <Rule Number>  
delete <Rule Number>  
Description  
Sets IP filter rules.  
Logging Commands  
set deviceport port  
Syntax  
set deviceport port <Device Port List or Name> <one or more deviceport  
parameters>  
Parameters  
emaildelay <Email Delay>  
emaillogging <disable|bytecnt|charstr>  
emailrestart <Restart Delay>  
emailsend <email|trap|both>  
emailstring <Regex String>  
emailsubj <Email Subject>  
emailthreshold <Byte Threshold>  
emailto <Email Address>  
filedir <Logging Directory>  
filelogging <enable|disable>  
filemaxfiles <Max # of Files>  
filemaxsize <Max Size of Files>  
locallogging <enable|disable>  
name <Device Port Name>  
nfsdir <Logging Directory>  
nfslogging <enable|disable>  
nfsmaxfiles <Max # of Files>  
nfsmaxsize <Size in Bytes>  
pccardlogging <enable|disable>  
pccardmaxfiles <Max # of Files>  
pccardmaxsize <Size in Bytes>  
pccardslot <upper|lower>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
sysloglogging <enable|disable>  
Description  
Configures logging settings for one or more device ports.  
Local logging must be enabled for a device port for the locallogcommands to be executed. To  
use the set locallog clearcommand, the user must have permission to clear port buffers  
Example  
set deviceport port 2-5,6,12,15-16 baud 2400 locallogging enable  
show locallog  
Syntax  
show locallog <Device Port # or Name> [bytes <Bytes To Display>]  
Description  
Displays a specific number of bytes of data for a device port. 1K is the default.  
set locallog clear  
Syntax  
set locallog clear <Device Port # or Name>  
Description  
Clears the local log for a device port.  
The locallogcommands can only be executed for a device port if local logging is enabled for  
the port. The set locallog clearcommand can only be executed if the user has permission  
to clear port buffers (see 11: User Authentication).  
Network Commands  
set network  
Syntax  
set network <parameters>  
Parameters  
interval <1-99999 Seconds>  
ipforwarding <enable|disable>  
probes <Number of Probes>  
startprobes <1-99999 Seconds>  
Description  
Sets TCP Keepalive and IP Forwarding network parameters.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
set network dns  
Syntax  
set network dns <1|2|3> ipaddr <IP Address>  
Description  
Configures up to three DNS servers.  
set network gateway  
Syntax  
set network gateway <parameters>  
Parameters  
default <IP Address>  
precedence <dhcp|gprs|default>  
alternate <IP Address>  
pingip <IP Address>  
ethport <1 or 2>  
pingdelay <1-250 seconds>  
failedpings <1-250>  
Description  
Sets default and alternate gateways. The alternate gateway is used if an IP address usually  
accessible through the default gateway fails to return one or more pings.  
set network host  
Syntax  
set network host <Hostname> [domain <Domain Name>]  
Description  
Sets the SLB host name and domain name.  
set network port  
Syntax  
set network port <1|2> <parameters>  
Parameters  
mode <auto|10mbit-half|100mbit-half|10mbit-full|100mbit-full>  
state <dhcp|bootp|static|disable>  
[ipaddr <IP Address> mask <Mask>]  
[ipv6addr <IP v6 Address/Prefix>]  
Description  
Configures Ethernet port 1 or 2.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
250  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
show network dns  
Syntax  
show network dns  
Description  
Displays DNS settings.  
show network gateway  
Syntax  
show network gateway  
Description  
Displays gateway settings.  
show network host  
Syntax  
show network host  
Description  
Displays the network host name of the SLB branch office manager.  
show network port  
Syntax  
show network port <1|2>  
Description  
Displays Ethernet port settings and counters.  
show network all  
Syntax  
show network all  
Description  
Displays all network settings.  
NFS and SMB/CIFS Commands  
set nfs mount  
Syntax  
set nfs mount <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
locdir <Directory>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
mount <enable|disable>  
remdir <Remote NFS Directory>  
rw <enable|disable>  
Enables or disables read/write access to remote directory.  
Description  
Mounts a remote NFS share.  
The remdirand locdirparameters are required, but if they have been specified previously,  
you do not need to provide them again.  
set nfs unmount  
Syntax  
set nfs unmount <1|2|3>  
Description  
Unmounts a remote NFS share.  
set cifs  
Syntax  
set cifs <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
eth1 <enable|disable>  
eth2 <enable|disable>  
state <enable|disable>  
workgroup <Windows workgroup>  
Description  
Configures the SMB/CIFS share, which contains the system and device port logs.  
Note: The admin config command saves SLB configurations on the SMB/CIFS share.  
set cifs password  
Syntax  
set cifs password  
Description  
Changes the password for the SMB/CIFS share login (default is cifsuser).  
show cifs  
Syntax  
show cifs  
Description  
Displays SMB/CIFS settings.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
252  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
show nfs  
Syntax  
show nfs  
Description  
Displays NFS share settings.  
PC Card Storage Commands  
pccard storage dir  
Syntax  
pccard storage dir <upper|lower>  
Description  
Views a directory listing of a Compact Flash card.  
pccard storage format  
Syntax  
pccard storage format <upper|lower> [filesystem <ext2|fat>]  
Description  
Formats a Compact Flash card.  
pccard storage mount  
Syntax  
pccard storage mount <upper|lower>  
Description  
Mounts a Compact Flash card in the SLB device for use as a storage device.  
The Compact Flash card must be formatted with an ext2 or FAT file system before you mount it.  
pccard storage unmount  
Syntax  
pccard storage unmount <upper|lower>  
Description  
Unmounts a Compact Flash card. Enter this command before ejecting the card.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
PC Card Modem Commands  
pccard modem  
Syntax  
pccard modem <upper|lower> <parameters>  
Parameters  
auth <pap|chap>  
baud <300-115200>  
9600 is the default.  
calleridcmd <Modem Command String>  
calleridlogging <enable| disable>  
chaphost <CHAP Host or User Password>  
chapsecret <CHAP Secret or User Password>  
databits <7|8>  
dialbacknumber <usernumber|Phone Number>  
dialoutlogin <User Login>  
dialoutnumber <Phone Number>  
dodauth <pap|chap>  
dodchaphost <CHAP Host or User Name>  
dodchapsecret <CHAP Secret or User Password>  
dialoutpassword <Password>  
flowcontrol <none|xon/xoff|rts|cts>  
gsmautodns <enable|disable>  
gsmbearerservice <GSM Bearer Service>  
gsmcompression <enable|disable>  
gsmcontext <GPRS Context Id>  
gsmdialoutmode <gprs|gsm>  
gsmpin <GSM/GPRS PIN Number>  
initscript <Initialization Script>  
isdnchannel <1|2>  
isdnnumber <Phone Number>  
localipaddr <negotiate|IP Address>  
modemmode <text|ppp>  
modemstate <disable|dialout|dialin|dialback|dialondemand|  
dialin+dialondemand>  
modemtimeout <disable|1-9999 seconds>  
parity <none|odd|even>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
254  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
remoteipaddr <negotiate|IP Address>  
restartdelay <PPP Restart Delay>  
service <none|telnet|ssh|tcp>  
sshauth <enable|disable>  
sshport <TCP Port>  
stopbits <1|2>  
tcpauth <enable|disable>  
tcpport <TCP Port>  
telnetauth <enable|disable>  
telnetport <TCP Port>  
timeoutlogins <disable|1-30>  
Description  
Configures a currently loaded PC Card.  
Power Commands  
set power alarmthreshold  
Syntax  
set power alarmthreshold <disable|Tenths of Amps>  
Description  
Number of amps (measured in tenths of an amp) above which the SLB branch office manager  
sends a trap. The maximum is 180.  
Note: If the alarm goes off, a warning message displays on the CLI.  
set power outlet  
Syntax  
set power outlet <Outlet # or List or Name> <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
name <Outlet Name>  
description <Outlet Description>  
state <on|off>  
wakeup <on|off|laststate>  
reboot  
Description  
Configures and controls power outlets.  
Example  
set power outlet 1-2,4 state on  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
set power switchingdelay  
Syntax  
set power switchingdelay <Delay in msec>  
Description  
Sets the delay after switching on an outlet before switching on the next.  
show power  
Syntax  
show power <Outlet # or Name>  
Description  
Displays power settings for all outlets or for a single outlet.  
Note: The screen displays PND when the outlet is powering up and is waiting for the delay period  
to expire. It displays RBT when an outlet has been told to reboot and is waiting for the reboot  
interval to expire (default is 20 seconds.) The switching delay and the reboot interval are  
completely independent of each other.  
Routing Commands  
set routing  
Syntax  
set routing [parameters]  
Parameters  
rip <enable|disable>  
route <1-64> ipaddr <IP Address> mask <Netmask> gateway <IP Address>  
static <enable|disable>  
version <1|2|both>  
Description  
Configures static or dynamic routing.  
To delete a static route, set the IP address, mask, and gateway parameters to 0.0.0.0.  
show routing  
Syntax  
show routing [resolveip <enable|disable>] [email <Email Address>]  
Description  
Sets the routing table to display IP addresses (disable) or the corresponding host names  
(enable). You can optionally email the displayed information.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
256  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
Services Commands  
set services  
Syntax  
set services <one or more services parameters>  
Parameters  
alarmdelay <1-6000 Seconds>  
auditlog <enable|disable>  
auditsize <Size in Kbytes>  
Limit is 1-500 Kbytes  
authlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
clicommands <enable|disable>  
contact <Admin contact info>  
devlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
diaglog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
genlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
includesyslog <enable|disable>  
location <Physical Location>  
netlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
nms <IP Address or Name>  
phonehome <enable|disable>  
phoneip <IP Address>  
portssh <TCP Port>  
rocommunity <Read-Only Community Name>  
rwcommunity <Read-Write Community Name>  
Sets a password for an SNMP manager to access the read-only data the SLB SNMP agent  
provides and to modify data where permitted.  
servlog <off|error|warning|info|debug>  
smtpserver <IP Address or Hostname>  
snmp <enable|disable>  
ssh <enable|disable>  
syslogserver1 <IP Address or Name>  
syslogserver2 <IP Address or Name>  
telnet <enable|disable>  
timeoutssh <disable or 1-30>  
timeouttelnet <disable or 1-30>  
traps <enable|disable>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
trapcommunity <Trap Community>  
v1ssh <enable|disable>  
v3password <Password for v3 auth>  
v3user <User for v3 auth>  
v3user <V3 RO User>  
v3password <V3 RO User Password>  
v3phrase <V3 RO User Passphrase>  
v3rwuser <V3 RW User>  
v3rwpassword <V3 RW User Password>  
v3rwphrase <V3 RW User Passphrase>  
v3security <noauth|auth|authencrypt>  
v3auth <md5|sha>  
v3encrypt <des|aes>  
webssh <enable|disable  
webtelnet <enable|disable>  
Description  
Configures services (system logging, SSH and Telnet access, SSH and Telnet timeout, SNMP  
agent, email (SMTP) server, and audit log):  
show services  
Syntax  
show services  
Description  
Displays current services.  
SLB Network Commands  
set slcnetwork  
Syntax  
set slcnetwork <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
add <IP Address>  
delete <IP Address>  
search <localsubnet|ipaddrlist|both>  
Description  
Detects and displays all SLB branch office manager or user-defined IP addresses on the local  
network.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
show slcnetwork  
Syntax  
show slcnetwork [ipaddrlist <all|Address Mask>]  
Description  
Detects and displays all SLB devices on the local network.  
Without the ipaddrlist parameter, the command searches the SLB network. With the  
ipaddrlistparameter, the command displays a sorted list of all IP addresses or displays the IP  
addresses that match the mask (for example, 172.19.255.255 would display all IP addresses that  
start with 172.19).  
SSH Key Commands  
set sshkey all export  
Syntax  
set sshkey allexport <ftp|scp|copypaste> [pubfile <Public Key  
File>][host <IP Address or Name>] [login <User Login>][path <Path to  
Copy Keys>]  
Description  
Exports the public keys all of the previously created SSH keys.  
set sshkey delete  
Syntax  
set sshkey delete <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
keyhost <SSH Key Host>  
keyname <SSH Key Name>  
keyuser <SSH Key User>  
Description  
Deletes an ssh key.  
Specify the keyuserand keyhostto delete an imported key; specify the keyuserand  
keynameto delete exported key.  
set sshkey export  
Syntax  
set sshkey export <ftp|scp|copypaste> <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
[format <openssh|secsh>]  
[host <IP Address or Name>]  
[login <User Login>]  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
[path <Path to Copy Key>]  
bits <512|1024>  
keyname <SSH Key Name>  
keyuser <SSH Key User>  
type <rsa|dsa>  
Description  
Exports an sshkey.  
set sshkey import  
set sshkey import <ftp|scp> <one or more parameters>  
Parameters  
[keyhost <SSH Key IP Address or Name>]  
[keyuser <SSH Key User>]  
[path <Path to Public Key File>]  
file <Public Key File>  
host <IP Address or Name>  
login <User Login>  
Description  
Imports an SSH key.  
set sshkey server import  
Syntax  
set sshkey server import type <rsa1|rsa|dsa> via <sftp|scp>  
pubfile <Public Key File> privfile <Private Key File>  
host <IP Address or Name> login <User Login> [path <Path to Key  
File>]  
Description  
Imports an SLB host key.  
set sshkey server reset  
Syntax  
set sshkey server reset [type <all|rsa1|rsa|dsa>]  
Description  
Resets defaults for all or selected host keys.  
show sshkey export  
Syntax  
show sshkey export <one or more parameters>  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
260  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14: Command Reference  
Parameters  
[keyhost <SSH Key IP Address or Name>]  
[keyuser <SSH Key User>]  
[viewkey <enable|disable>]  
Description  
Displays all exported keys or keys for a specific user, IP address, or name.  
show sshkey import  
Syntax  
show sshkey import <one or more parameters>]  
Parameters  
[keyhost <SSH Key IP Address or Name>]  
[keyuser <SSH Key User>]  
[viewkey <enable|disable>]  
Description  
Displays all keys that have been imported or keys for a specific user, IP address, or name.  
show sshkey server  
Syntax  
show sshkey server [type <all|rsa1|rsa|dsa>]  
Description  
Displays host keys (public key only).  
Status Commands  
show connections  
Syntax  
show connections [email <Email Address>]  
Description  
Displays a list of current connections. Optionally emails the displayed information. The connection  
IDs are in the left column of the resulting table. The connection ID associated with a particular  
connection may change if the connection times out and is restarted.  
show connections connid  
Syntax  
show connections connid <Connection ID> [email <Email Address>].  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
Description  
Provides details, for example, endpoint parameters and trigger, for a specific connection.  
Optionally emails the displayed information.  
Note: Use the basic show connectionscommand to obtain the Connection ID.  
show portcounters  
Syntax  
show portcounters [deviceport <Device Port List or Name>] [email <Email  
Address>]  
Description  
Generates a report for one or more ports. Optionally emails the displayed information.  
show portstatus  
Syntax  
show portstatus [deviceport <Device Port List or Name>] [email <Email  
Address>]  
Description  
Displays device port modes and states for one or more ports. Optionally emails the displayed  
information.  
show sysconfig  
Syntax  
show sysconfig [display <basic|auth|devices>] [email <Email Address]  
Description  
Displays a snapshot of all configurable parameters. Optionally emails the displayed information.  
show sysstatus  
Syntax  
show sysstatus [email <Email Address>]  
Description  
To display the overall status of all SLB devices. Optionally emails the displayed information.  
System Log Commands  
show syslog  
Syntax  
show syslog [<parameters>]  
Parameters  
[email <Email Address>]  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
262  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14: Command Reference  
level <error|warning|info|debug>  
log <all|netlog|servlog|authlog|devlog|diaglog|genlog>  
display <head|tail> [numlines <Number of Lines>]  
starttime <MMDDYYhhmm[ss]>  
endtime <MMDDYYhhmm[ss]>  
Description  
Displays the system logs containing information and error messages.  
Note: The level, display, and time parameters cannot be used simultaneously.  
show syslog clear  
Syntax  
show syslog clear <all|netlog|servlog|authlog|devlog|diaglog|genlog>  
Description  
Clears one or all of the system logs.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A: Bootloader  
The SLM management appliance provides a bootload command interface. This interface  
is only accessible through the SLB branch office manager’s console port.  
Accessing the Bootloader  
To access the bootloader CLI:  
To access the bootloader command line interface  
1. Power up the SLB branch office manager.  
2. Type x15 within 10 seconds of power up. The bootloader halts the boot procedure  
and displays a Lantronix command prompt.  
Bootload Commands  
User Commands  
help  
Lists and prints the command list and online help.  
?
An alias for help.  
boot  
Boot default (runs bootcmd).  
bootcheck  
Checks boot bank information.  
bootinfo  
Displays boot bank information.  
bootsel 1|2  
Selects boot bank 1 or boot bank 2.  
IDE  
Accesses the IDE sub-system.  
mtest  
Performs a simple test of the RAM.  
su cust|admin  
Switches to another user: from cust (customer) to adm (administrator) and vice versa.  
version  
Prints the bootloader version.  
whoami  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
264  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
A: Bootloader  
Displays information about the current user.  
Administrator Commands  
In addition to the commands that the user can issue, the administrator can issue the  
following commands:  
imagecopy  
Copies an image of the drive from the lower PCMCIA device to the internal CF card.  
passwd  
Provides a new password for user admin. The default password for user adminis  
admin. User custdoes not have a password.  
ping  
Sends a ping request to the network host.  
printenv  
Prints bootloader variables.  
setenv  
Sets environment variables.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
B: Security Considerations  
The SLB branch office manager provides data path security by means of SSH or  
Web/SSL. Even with the use of SSH/SSL, however, do not assume you have complete  
security. Securing the data path is only one measure needed to ensure security. This  
appendix briefly discusses some important security considerations.  
Security Practice  
Develop and document a Security Practice. The Security Practice should state:  
The dos and don’ts of maintaining security. For example, the power of SSH and  
SSL is compromised if users leave sessions open or advertise their password.  
The assumptions that users can make about the facility and network  
infrastructure, for example, how vulnerable the CAT 5 wiring is to tapping.  
Factors Affecting Security  
External factors affect the security provided by the SLB device, for example:  
Telnet sends the login exchange as clear text across Ethernet. A person  
snooping on a subnet may read your password.  
A terminal to the SLB branch office manager may be secure, but the path from  
the SLB device to the end device may not be secure.  
With the right tools, a person having physical access to open the SLB branch  
office manager may be able to read the encryption keys.  
There is no true test for a denial-of-service attack—there is always a legitimate  
scenario for a request storm. A denial-of-service filter locks out some high-  
performance automated/scripted requests. The SLB device will attempt to service  
all requests and will not filter out potential denial–of-service attacks.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
266  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
C: Safety Information  
Safety Precautions  
Please follow the safety precautions described below when installing and operating the  
SLB branch office manager.  
Cover  
Do not remove the cover of the chassis. There are no user-serviceable parts  
inside. Opening or removing the cover may expose you to dangerous voltage  
that could cause fire or electric shock.  
Refer all servicing to Lantronix.  
Power Plug  
When disconnecting the power cable from the socket, pull on the plug, not  
the cord.  
Always connect the power cord to a properly wired and grounded power  
source. Do not use adapter plugs or remove the grounding prong from the  
cord.  
Only use a power cord with a voltage and current rating greater than the  
voltage and current rating marked on the SLB branch office manager.  
Install the SLB device near an AC outlet that is easily accessible.  
Always connect any equipment used with the product to properly wired and  
grounded power sources.  
To help protect the product from sudden, transient increases and decreases  
in electrical power, use a surge suppressor, line conditioner, or  
uninterruptible power supply (UPS).  
Do not connect or disconnect this product during an electrical storm.  
Input Supply  
This SLB branch office manager may have more than one power supply source.  
Disconnect all power supply sources before servicing to avoid electric shock.  
Check nameplate ratings to assure there is no overloading of supply circuits  
that could affect over current protection and supply wiring.  
Grounding  
Maintain reliable grounding of this product.  
Pay particular attention to supply connections when connecting to power  
strips, rather than directly to the branch circuit.  
Install DC-rated equipment only under the following conditions:  
Connect the equipment to a DC supply source that is electrically isolated from the  
AC source and reliably connected to ground, or connect it to a DC (SELV) source.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
C: Safety Information  
Install only in restricted access areas (dedicated equipment rooms, equipment  
closets or the like) in accordance with Articles 110-16,  
110-17, and 110-18 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70.  
Route and secure input wiring to terminal block in such a manner that it is  
protected from damage and stress. Do not route wiring past sharp edges or  
moving parts.  
Incorporate a readily accessible disconnect device, with a 3 mm minimum contact  
gap, in the fixed wiring.  
Provide a listed circuit breaker suitable for protection of the branch circuit wiring  
and rated 60 VDC minimum.  
Fuses  
For protection against fire, replace the power-input-module fuse with the  
same type and rating.  
Rack  
If rack mounted SLB devices are installed in a closed or multi-unit rack assembly, they  
may require further evaluation by Certification Agencies. The following items must be  
considered:  
Do not install the SLB branch office manager in a rack in such a way that a  
hazardous stability condition results because of uneven loading. A drop or  
fall could cause injury.  
The ambient temperature (Tma) inside the rack may be greater than the  
room ambient temperature. Make sure to install the SLB device in an  
environment with an ambient temperature less than the maximum operating  
temperature of the SLB branch office manager. (See Technical  
Install the equipment in a rack in such a way that the amount of airflow  
required for safe operation of the equipment is not compromised.  
Mount the equipment in the rack so that a hazardous condition is not  
achieved due to uneven mechanical loading.  
Maintain reliable earthing of rack-mounted equipment. Give particular  
attention to supply connections other than direct connections to the branch  
circuit (e.g. use of power strips).  
Before operating the SLB device, make sure the SLB branch office manager  
is secured to the rack.  
Port Connections  
Only connect the network port to an Ethernet network that supports 10Base-  
T/100Base-T.  
Only connect device ports to equipment with serial ports that support EIA-  
232 (formerly RS-232C).  
Only connect the console port to equipment with serial ports that support  
EIA-232 (formerly RS-232C).  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D: Adapters and Pinouts  
The serial device ports of the SLB branch office manager products match the RJ45  
pinouts of the console ports of many popular devices found in a network environment.  
The SLB device uses conventional straight-through Category 5 fully pinned network  
cables for all connections when used with Lantronix adapters. The cables are available in  
various lengths.  
In most cases, you will need an adapter for your serial devices. Lantronix offers a variety  
of RJ45-to-serial connector adapters for many devices. These adapters convert the RJ45  
connection on the SLB branch office manager to a 9-pin or 25-pin serial connector found  
on other manufacturers' serial devices or re-route the serial signals for connections to  
other devices that use RJ45 serial connectors.  
Please check the cabling database on the Lantronix website at http://www.lantronix.com  
for suggested cables and adapters for commonly used serial devices.  
The console port is wired the same way as the device ports and has the same signal  
options.  
Note: You can view or change the console port settings using the LCDs and  
pushbuttons on the front panel, the Console Port web page, or the command line  
interface show console port and set consoleport commands.  
The adapters illustrated below are compatible with the Lantronix SLB models.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
D: Adapters and Pinouts  
RJ45 Receptacle to DB25M DCE Adapter for the SLB Device (PN 200.2066A)  
Pin 1  
1
DB25 Male  
RJ45  
RTS 1  
5
8
6
DTR 2  
3
7
Tx 3  
Gnd 4  
Gnd 5  
Rx 6  
2
20  
4
DSR 7  
CTS 8  
Use PN 200.2066A adapter with a dumb terminal or with many SUN applications.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
270  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D: Adapters and Pinouts  
RJ45 Receptacle to DB25F DCE Adapter for the SLB Device (PN 200.2067A)  
Pin 1  
1
DB25 Female  
RJ45  
5
RTS 1  
8
6
DTR 2  
Tx 3  
3
7
Gnd 5  
Rx 6  
2
20  
4
DSR 7  
CTS 8  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D: Adapters and Pinouts  
RJ45 Receptacle to DB9M DCE Adapter for the SLB Device (PN 200.2069A)  
Pin 1  
1
DB9 Male  
RJ45  
8
RTS 1  
1
6
DTR 2  
2
5
Tx 3  
Gnd 4  
Gnd 5  
3
Rx 6  
DSR 7  
CTS 8  
4
7
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
272  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D: Adapters and Pinouts  
RJ45 Receptacle to DB9F DCE Adapter for the SLB Device (PN 200.2070A)  
Pin 1  
1
DB9 Female  
RJ45  
8
RTS 1  
DTR 2  
1
6
2
5
Tx 3  
Gnd 4  
Gnd 5  
Rx 6  
3
4
7
DSR 7  
CTS 8  
Use PN 200.2070A adapter with a PC's serial port.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D: Adapters and Pinouts  
RJ45 to RJ45 Adapter for Netra/Sun/Cisco and SLP Device (PNs 200.2225 and ADP010104-01)  
Note: The cable ends of the ADP010104-01 are an RJ45 socket on one end and a  
RJ45 plug on the other instead of RJ45 sockets on both ends.  
RTS 1  
DTR 2  
Tx 3  
Gnd 4  
Gnd 5  
Rx 6  
DSR 7  
CTS 8  
Use this adapter for the SLP power manager, Netra/SUN/CISCO, and others.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E: Protocol Glossary  
BOOTP (Bootstrap Protocol)  
Similar to DHCP, but for smaller networks. Automatically assigns the IP address for a  
specific duration of time.  
CHAP (Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol)  
A secure protocol for connecting to a system; it is more secure than the PAP.  
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)  
Internet protocol for automating the configuration of computers that use TCP/IP.  
DNS (Domain Name Servers): A system that allows a network nameserver to translate  
text host names into numeric IP addresses.  
Kerberos  
A network authentication protocol that provides strong authentication for client/server  
applications by using secret-key cryptography.  
LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocol)  
A protocol for accessing directory information.  
NAT (Network Address Translation)  
An Internet standard that enables a LAN to use one set of IP addresses for internal traffic  
and a second set of addresses for external traffic. This enables a company to shield  
internal addresses from the public Internet.  
NFS (Network File System)  
A protocol that allows file sharing across a network. Users can view, store, and update  
files on a remote computer. You can use NFS to mount all or a portion of a file system.  
Users can access the portion mounted with the same privileges as the user’s access to  
each file.  
NIS (Network Information System)  
System developed by Sun Microsystems for distributing system data such as user and  
host names among computers on a network.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
E: Protocol Glossary  
NMS (Network Management System)  
NMS acts as a central server, requesting and receiving SNMP-type information from any  
computer using SNMP.  
NTP (Network Time Protocol)  
A protocol used to synchronize time on networked computers and equipment.  
PAP (Password Authentication Protocol)  
A method of user authentication in which the username and password are transmitted  
over a network and compared to a table of name-password pairs.  
PPP (Point-to-Point Protocol)  
A protocol for creating and running IP and other network protocols over a serial link.  
RADIUS (Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service)  
An authentication and accounting protocol. Enables remote access servers to  
communicate with a central server to authenticate dial-in users and their access  
permissions. A company stores user profiles in a central database that all remote servers  
can share.  
SMB/CIFS  
(Server Message Block/Common Internet File System): Microsoft’s protocol for allowing  
all applications as well as Web browsers to share files across the Internet. CIFS runs on  
TCP/IP and uses the SMB protocol in Microsoft Windows for accessing files. With CIFS,  
users with different platforms and computers can share files without having to install new  
software.  
SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol)  
A protocol that system administrators use to monitor networks and connected devices  
and to respond to queries from other network hosts.  
SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol)  
TCP/IP protocol for sending email between servers.  
SSL (Secure Sockets Layer)  
A protocol that provides authentication and encryption services between a web server  
and a web browser.  
SSH (Secure Shell)  
A secure transport protocol based on public-key cryptography.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E: Protocol Glossary  
TACACS+ (Terminal Access Controller Access Control System)  
A method of authentication used in UNIX networks. It allows a remote access server to  
communicate with an authentication server to determine whether the user has access to  
the network.  
Telnet  
A terminal protocol that provides an easy-to-use method of creating terminal connections  
to a network host.  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F: Compliance Information  
Manufacturer’s Name & Address:  
Lantronix, Inc., 167 Technology Drive, Irvine, CA 92618 USA  
Declares that the following product:  
Product Name(s): SLB Branch Office Manager (SLB Series)  
Conforms to the following standards or other normative documents:  
SAFETY:  
UL 60950-1  
CAN/CSA-C22.2 No. 60950-1-03  
EN 60950-1 (2001), Low Voltage Directive (73/23/EEC)  
FCC NOTICE (U.S. Only)  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A  
digital device pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to  
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment  
is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and  
can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance  
with the manufacturer's instruction manual, may cause harmful interference with  
radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely  
to cause harmful interference, in which case you will be required to correct the  
interference at your own expense.  
INDUSTRY CANADA NOTICE (Canada Only)  
This Class A digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe A est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du  
Canada.  
CE NOTICE (European Union Only)  
Marking by the symbol  
indicates compliance of this information technology  
device to the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive of the European  
Union. Such marking is indicative that this system meets the following technical  
standards:  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
278  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
F: Compliance Information  
EN 55022 — “Limits and Methods of Measurement of Radio Interference  
Characteristics of Information Technology Equipment.”  
EN 55024 — “Information technology equipment - Immunity characteristics -  
Limits and methods of measurement.”  
EN 61000-3-2 — “Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - Part 3: Limits -  
Section 2: Limits for harmonic current emissions (Equipment input current up  
to and including 16 A per phase).”  
EN 61000-3-3 — “Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - Part 3: Limits -  
Section 3: Limitation of voltage fluctuations and flicker in low-voltage supply  
systems for equipment with rated current up to and including 16 A.”  
EN 60950 — “Safety of Information Technology Equipment.”  
RoHS Compliance  
This product meets the requirements of 2002/95/EC European RoHS and also  
complies with the SJ/T 11363-2006 Peoples Republic of China, Requirements for  
Concentration Limits on Certain Hazardous Substances in Information  
Technology Products.  
Additional Agency Approvals and Certifications:  
VCCI  
UL/CUL  
C-Tick  
NIST-certified implementation of AES as specified by FIPS 197 (uses SLC-  
SSH algorithm)  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F: Compliance Information  
RoHS Notice:  
All Lantronix products in the following families are China RoHS-compliant and free of the following hazardous  
substances and elements:  
Lead (Pb)  
Cadmium (Cd)  
Mercury (Hg)  
Hexavalent Chromium (Cr (VI))  
Polybrominated biphenyls (PBB)  
Polybrominated diphenyl ethers (PBDE)  
Product Family Name  
Toxic or hazardous Substances and Elements  
Lead  
(Pb)  
Mercury  
(Hg)  
Cadmium  
(Cd)  
Hexavalent  
Chromium  
Polybrominated  
biphenyls (PBB)  
Polybrominated diphenyl  
ethers (PBDE)  
(Cr (VI))  
UDS1100 and 2100  
EDS  
MSS100  
IntelliBox  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
XPress DR & XPress-DR+  
SecureBox 1101  
WiBox  
UBox  
MatchPort  
SLC  
XPort  
WiPort  
SLB  
SLP  
SCS  
SLS  
O: toxic or hazardous substance contained in all of the homogeneous materials for this part is below the limit requirement in SJ/T11363-2006.  
X: toxic or hazardous substance contained in at least one of the homogeneous materials used for this part is above the limit requirement in SJ/T11363-2006.  
Manufacturer’s Contact:  
Lantronix Inc.  
167 Technology Drive  
Irvine, CA 92618, USA  
Toll Free: 800-526-8766  
Phone:  
Fax:  
949-453-3990  
949-453-3995  
SLB™ Branch Office Manager User Guide  
280  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

La Crosse Technology Clock WT 3181pl User Manual
Lego Games 75035 User Manual
Lenoxx Electronics Furnace 2P0803 User Manual
Liebherr Freezer FDV4613 User Manual
Linear Stereo Receiver RV5060 User Manual
Locke Lawn Mower Accessory TR 30 User Manual
Mackie Music Mixer ONYX 820i User Manual
Magnavox CD Player AZ 6839 User Manual
Maytag Clothes Dryer MDG50PCC User Manual
Memorex Answering Machine MPH2089 User Manual